英语七年级上册课件
发布时间:2023-10-04 英语七年级上册课件 七年级上册课件 七年级课件英语七年级上册课件(精品14篇)。
古人云,工欲善其事,必先利其器。当幼儿园教师的教学任务遇到困难时,往往都需要参考一下我们提前准备参考资料。资料是时代的记录,它是产生于人类实践活动。有了资料,这样接下来工作才会更上一层楼!所以,你是否知晓幼师资料到底是怎样的形式呢?以下是小编收集整理的“英语七年级上册课件(精品14篇)”,仅供参考,我们来看看吧!
英语七年级上册课件 篇1
一、教材分析
本单元是人教版《新目标》的第六单元。这本教材的词汇量很大,内容新颖,尤其是生动活泼的卡通化的画面,很符合七年级学生的年龄特点和心理特点,其中还囊括了很丰富多彩的文化知识,以及合作探究的活动,十分贴近学生的实际生活经验。
本单元的主要话题food与日常生活密切相关,贴近学生生活,能引起学生的特别关注,易激发学生学习英语的欲望和兴趣,是学生乐于参与各种英语实践活动,这是英语新课程标准中规定所必须掌握的内容,是交际英语中必不可少的项目。因此,本单元对于提升学生的学习兴趣而提高学生的听、说、读、写能力有很大的帮助。并通过self check检测,积极地、及时地寻找各自的不足,以便学生树立良好的内在动机,不断获得成就感。
二、教学目标
1、教学目标
⑴知识目标
Section A主要话题是食物及偏好,其中主要涉及内容如下:
A、Functions功能:谈论喜欢和不喜欢的食物、
B、Structures语法结构:动词like的肯定句,否定句,疑问句及其回答;主语是单数第三人称时like的用法,助动词do的用法、
C、Target Language日常交际用语:
Do you like salad?Yes,I do、 No,I don’t、
I like bananas、
I don’t like apples、
Does he/she like salad?Yes,he/ she does、 No,he/ she doesn’t、
He/ She likes apples、
He/ She doesn’t like apples、
D、Vocabulary词汇:like,banana,hamburger,tomato,broccoli,French fries,orange,ice cream,salad,strawberry等。
(2)能力目标
培养学生运用所学句型谈论喜好和饮食习惯。
(3)情感目标
通过询问他人喜好的食物和事物,学会关心他人,增进彼此感情、
通过学习,使学生养成健康饮食习惯、
2、教学重点、难点
(1)重点:学习并运用谈论喜好及食物的交际用语及词汇。
(2)难点:动词like肯定句,否定句,疑问句及回答的用法。以及单三人称的使用
3、教具准备:多媒体支持,大量相关图片,动画以及资料
4、课时安排:本课是unit 6的第一节课,包括Section A全部P31—P33、
三、 教学设计理念
本课时教学设计强调从学生的学习兴趣,生活经验和认知水平出发,结合学生实际,谈论学校喜欢和不喜欢的食物。提倡采用任务型语言教学途径和方法,鼓励学生在教师的指导下,通过体验、实践、参与、探索和合作等方式,发现语言的规律,逐步掌握语言知识和技能,不断调整情感态度,形成有效的学习策略和自主学习能力。
四、教学方法
1、听说法:以听、说、读、写、练为主,通过对本课重点句型的学习培养学生听力、口语以及书面语的能力。
2、交际法:注意语言的运用能力,培养学以致用的意识,有利于激发学生的学习兴趣和相互作用。
五、学法分析
新课标准强调以学生为中心,学生作为学习的主体,教师的主要任务是帮助学生形成有效的学习策略,发展自主学习的能力。在本课教学中,教师应引导学生:
1、每个都有自己喜欢和不喜欢的事物,学会询问他人也就学会了与人和谐相处,大家应养成经常使用英语谈论的习惯,提高口语能力。
2、学习英语不是一朝一夕的事,要求学生长期练习,多听、多说、多练,只有坚持不懈才能学习好英语。
六、说教学程序。
本课主要学习句型Do you like salad?Yes,I do、 No,I don’t、 I like bananas、 I don’t like apples、 Does he/she like salad?Yes,he/ she does、 No,he/ she doesn’t、 He/ She likes apples、 He/ She doesn’t like apples、运用这些句型谈论食物及喜好
七、教学过程
1、导入设计:教师事先安排学生看一段小故事,引出Do you like …?Yes,I do、No,I don’t、
2、整体感知:
(1)充分利用图片以及实物进行直观教学,引出本课的主题—food,like
(2)呈现大量图片,并引导学生谈论图上的食物以及个人喜好
(3)检测讨论学习结果,完成la里的内容。
(4)听力检测:听录音完成lb里的内容
(5)、Pair work角色扮演。学生4人一组,用所学语言问答练习、进一步熟悉所学语言:单词及句型,训练学生口语、
(6)做练习2a和2b,进一步练习学生听力、
(7)播放另一段故事引出Does he/she like salad?Yes,he/ she does、 No,he/ she doesn’t、 He/ She likes apples、 He/ She doesn’t like apples、运用这些句型谈论食物及喜好、复习单三、
(8)给出图画,让学生谈论名人的喜好,练习单三用法
(9)用同一幅图,让学生写出句子,练习以第一人称和第三人称方式写文章、给出时间写文章并读出来,练习读写能力、
3、总结本课,巩固知识、
把主要内容重新展示,并留出HW,巩固学习成果、
英语七年级上册课件 篇2
新目标英语七年级上册Unit3 SectionA说课稿
谢燕娥 尊敬的各位评委老师:
你们好!今天我说课的题目是新目标英语七年级上册第三单元Unit3 This is my sister.中的SectionA部分,整个说课我将分成六个大部分进行讲述:即 教材分析、学情分析、教法、学法、教学过程 及 板书设计。
第一板块:教材分析
(一)、说教材
《新目标英语》教材的语言教育理念是:知识用于行动,强调“语言应用”,培养“创新实践能力”,发展“学习策略”。它采用任务型语言教学模式。教材中每单元都设计一个或几个与该单元话题有关的任务,让学生在完成任务的过程中,使用英语获取信息,用英语进行交流,培养运用英语解决实际问题的能力。本课是新目标英语七年级上册第三单元第一课时,教材以This is my sister.为中心话题,围绕着谈论有关家庭成员的用语,并学会询问别人的情况,介绍自己的家庭,谈论自己的情感。并在此任务中认识到名词复数的概念及其运用。
(二)、教学目标
1.知识目标:a)学习单词: mother.father.brother.sister.these.are.those 等b)学习并掌握句型:Is this your sister?No, it isn’t./ Yes, it is.This is my friend.These are my friends.That is my brother.Those are my brothers.2.能力目标:通过Introduce people和Identify people使学生学会介绍他人和
识别他人,掌握基本This is/ That is...These are/ Those are…
等句型,培养学生实际交际的能力。
3.情感目标:通过介绍家人和朋友,对学生进行亲情教育,使他们学会感恩。
(三)、教学重难点
1.重点;学习重点单词,句型和语法点: This is my friend.These are my
friends.That is my brother.Those are my brothers.2.难点:名词复数形式及其正确的运用
第二板块:学情分析
七年级的学生正处于青春期发育期,他们有较高的求知欲和表现欲,希望自己的表现能得到同学和老师的认可。且该阶段学生已具备初步的语言表达能力和较强的记忆力与模拟能力。对他们所熟悉的话题学生的爱好会更浓,而本单元的话题正符合这一特点,所以我就设计任务型的课堂活动,让学生人人参与,增强他们学习的积极性和学习的自信心。
第三板块:说教法
新教材重视以人为本,强调素质教育。在教学中,要注意发挥学生的主体作用,把空间留给学生。抓住初中生活泼好动,表现欲强的心理特点,课堂上我设计了大量听、说、读、写的训练,启发学生动脑思考,鼓励学生大胆开口,畅所欲言,尽可能运用英语表达实际意义,从而最大限度地调动学生的积极性和主动性。教学中,我主要采用任务型教学法,情景结合教学法,分层法和通过学习五步教学法,精讲巧练,由浅入深,由易到难,由已知到未知,循序渐近地深化教学内容。展开以教师为主导,以学生为主体的师生双边活动。
第四板块:学法指导
1.引导学生用小组合作学生的方式来完成任务型教学所设计的各项活动。全班分为7个小组,每组6-7人,各组英语水平相当,并引入竞争机制。培养学生的实际能力,发展学生的合作能力。
2.采取的教学手段是多媒体辅助教学,充分利用农村中小学现代远程教育资源,自制课件,用生动的课件调动学生的感官,进行听说读写的训练。培养学生的观察力和想象力,发展学生的思维能力。
第五板块:教学过程
Step 1.Leading-in 创设情景,导入新课
出示一些实物,如钢笔、钥匙、尺子等,用下面句型引导学生与同伴之
间进行交谈。复习前面学过的句型,为新授作好铺垫。
S1: Is this your pen?-----Yes, it is.S2:Is that her ruler?-----No, it isn’t.It’s my ruler.Step 2.Presentation 新课讲解,呈现教学内容
我先出示一张照片,通过创设情景,师生对话,引出新知识: e.g.:T:What is this ?------Ss: It’s a photo.T:Is this your photo?-------Ss: No, it isn’t.-------
T:It’s not your photo.It’s my photo.And this is my sister.从而引出本课时重点句型: This is my sister.并在此基础上讲解“this
is…”是用来向对方介绍他人的。同时运用这句型“This is…”进行教学新单词:mother , father , sister , brother , grandfather 等所有家庭成员。让学生先对本课所要讲的内容有个初步的感知,激发学生进一步学习的动机。Step 3.Practicing反复操练,巩固运用
为了调动学生的积极性,主动深化短时记忆中的信息,并逐步向长时
记忆迈进、发展。我将利用多媒体生动活泼呈现多张家庭成员图片。让学生将单词与图中人物匹配,认识家庭成员。并学会使用This / That is my …和 These are / Those are … 介绍家人和朋友,巩固知识、操练知识。在此同时,要注意与讲解名词的复数形式 以及 让学生能够正确的运用。
Step 4.Listening and doing口语操练,加深印象
学生通过前面的学习,已经对新的知识形成了初步的新知识结构,但
在名词复数结构上还存在着模糊点,这时通过一系列的综合练习可以巩固、发展及完善学生的知识结构。
a)通过播放1b录音,学生听,模仿说,完成任务,巩固语言材料,培养
学生听说能力。
b)让学生准备几分钟,运用本课所学的句型“This / That is …”和“These /
Those are …”对1a 中戴夫家庭成员进行介绍。进一步巩固本课的重难点。
c)对学生进行分组,分别完成2c对话之后。让学生用自己的照片,编出自
己的对话,到前面进行对话表演。转换角色,练习对话。
Step nsolidating课堂练习,巩固知识
在学生已在大脑中构建新的认知结构基础上,提供适当的课堂练习,不仅能让学生在实践中自我学习、自我改进、达到自我完善;而且能够充分地让学生体会到“知识的获得并不只是单方面的‘输入’过程,更重要的是知识的‘输出’” 也就是说能够根据外部实际情况对新知识准确地提取并加以运用。
因此我会出示一些与本课语言点相关的选择题和情景对话,要求学生当场完成。课堂练习的目的在于检查学生掌握知识的情况以便教师发现学生缺漏,及时补充。同时也有助于进一步巩固,加强对本课内容的理解和运用。Step 6.Homework课外作业
1.掌握所学词汇。
2.向同学介绍家人或朋友。
第六板块:板书设计
板书反映出一节课内容的知识体系,精心设计的板书,它既有利于教师帮助学生的思路,又有利于学生掌握教学的重难点,从而提高课堂教学的效果。也有助于把学生思维中已有的知识作重调整,让散乱的知识边的条理清楚,同时也让学生学会把所学的知识进行归纳、概括。不仅可以促使学生积极思考,而且对于提高学生的分析、比较、判断的能力,有积极的作用,还使学生获得的知识不容易遗忘。
Section AUnit 3
New words:Grammars:
mother, father, sister, brother,Is this your sister?
parent,grandfather,grandmother,-----Yes, it is./ No, it isn’t.friend, these, are, those.This / That is my friend.These / Those are my friends.以上就是我说课的整个内容,谢谢。
英语七年级上册课件 篇3
一、Teaching materials:
Unit 3 Language in use (Module 10 Life history)
二、Targets for this perio d:
To summarize and consolidate past simple questions and negative sentences and the new vocabulary
三、Key points:
Key vocabulary— in, a lot
Key structures—Did you do…? Yes, I did. / No, I didn’t.
We didn’t do ….
四、Teaching methods:
Task-based approach, formal and interactive approach
五、Teaching aids
Blackboard, handouts
六、Teaching arrangements:
Step One To translate the sentences into English
1. 当你是个小男孩时,你骑自行车去上学吗?
Did you ride a bike to school when you were a boy?
2. 他是世界上最出名的作家之一。
He is one of the most famous wri ters in the world.
3. 七、八月份,我和哥哥拜访了住在海边的阿姨。
In July and August, my brother and I visited my aunt near the sea.
4. 莎士比亚是一个戏剧家和诗人
Shakespeare is a writer of plays and poems.
5. 1950年人们不使用移动电话和 计算机。
In 1950 people didn’t use cell phones or computer.
6. 当他在十四岁毕业时他决定当一名演员。
He decided to be an actor when he finished school at the age of f ourteen.
7. 你爹妈什么时候结婚的?
When did your mother and father marry?
8. 二十八岁时他迁往伦敦并加入一家剧团。
At twenty-eight he moved to London and joined a theatre company.
9. 他成了一名成功的演员并开始写戏剧。
He became a successful actor and started writing plays.
10. 你仍然能看到他的英文版和许多其他语言版的剧本。
You still see his plays in English and in many other languages.
Step Two To c omplete the con versation (Activity 1)
1. Students finish it by themselves.
2. Check the answers in pairs.
3. Two student act out the conversation.
4. Detailed explanation:
1) in +原料 / 颜色
e.g: He is in black.
He wrote a diary in ink. Cp: He wrote a diary with a pen.
2) a lot = very much ; often
e.g: He learned a lot when he was a child.
Step Three To use the conversation in Activity 1 to write about your parents. (Activity 3)
1. Students finish it by themselves.
2. Students read aloud their passage in the front of the classroom.
(Students should pay attention to the tense)
Example: My parents didn’t use computers at school when they were young. They watched TV with plain color and few channels. Sometimes they played f ootball and tennis in the park.
Step Four To learn about l ife in the past (Around the world)
1. Students read the passage and answer questions.
1) Did people use computers in 1950? No, they didn’t.
2) Was there satellite TV or Internet in the past? No, there wasn’t.
3) Why did people travel by bike or by bus? Because Cars were expensive.
4) Did they go to other countries on holiday? NO, they didn’t.
2. Students read it aloud.
Step Five To answer the questions according to the actual life ( Activity 5)
1. Students do it by themselves.
2. Studen ts work in pairs.
Step Six To finish all the exercises in Workbook
Homework:
1. To review Module 10 and copy all the words and expressions in P159
2. To finish Module 10, 点中典 & 轻巧夺冠
英语七年级上册课件 篇4
课前准备
教师:准备游戏时所用的图片(食物、蔬菜、动物)。
学生:准备表演时所需道具(服装、假发)。
教学设计
Step One :Present the sentence patterns.1.Play a game “How many words do you know?”(利用小游戏调动学生的积极性,同时通过对冠军的介绍引出本课。)
Teacher: After the study of the first three starters, I think most of the students must have known a lot of words.How many words do you know? Let’s play a game to see who know? Let’s play a game to see who knows the most.(Divide all the students into several groups and show a picture(图片略)to them with the computer.Every group can choose two students to join.They are asked to come to the blackboard and write down the words in 30 seconds.)
(Group 2 is the champion group.They can write 11 words.)
2.Introduce the champion group to the class.(引课方式贴近生活,学生易于接受)
Teacher: Congratulations, now Group 2 is the champion.But I don’t know your names.Would you like to introduce yourselves to us?
S1& S2:Yes.S1:Hello.My name is Li Lei.Nice to meet you.Ss: Hello, Li Lei.Nice to meet you ,too.Ss: Hello!What’s your name?
S2:I’m Sun Ping.How do you do?
Ss: How do you do ?
Step Two: Drills.1.Make introductions.(通过句型的操练使学生更加熟练掌握所学的句式。)
Teacher: The new term begins.Everyone will meet many new classmates.Do you want to make friends with them? If your answer is “yes”, please introduce yourself in your group.Example:
Sa: Hello!I’m Li Lei.What’s your name?
Sb: My name’s Zhang Feng.Nice to meet you.Sa: Nice to meet you, too.And what’s your name, please?
Sc: Lin Li.How do you do?
Sa:How do you do?
2.Listen and number the conversations.Teacher: Today I have good news for you.Three new students will come to our class.They are from other countries.Do you want to know them? Let’s listen to the recording of 1b in Section A.(Students listen to the tape and give the right answers.)
Step Three: Make friends.1.Make new friends.(用谈话的方式完成任务,生动活泼,同时更容易向学生进行美德教育。)
Teacher: Now everyone has some new friends.Do you want others to know them? Do you want more friends? Let’s introduce our new friends to others, OK?
Ss: OK.Example:
Sa: This is my new friend.His name is Sun Nan.Sb: Hello, Sun Nan.Nice to meet you.Sc: Nice to meet you, too.Look!This is my new friend.Her name is He Lu.Ss: How do you do?
Sd: How do you do?
(Students can stand up and introduce their friends to others freely.They can greet each other warmly.Everyone in the class can have more friends.They can also know something else about them.)
2.The New comers.(以表演的形式完成,使课堂气氛达到高潮。)
Teacher: Just now I said three new students from other countries would come to our class.Now, look!They are here.Let’s give them a warm welcome.(Three “foreign”students come in and all the students clap warmly.)
Teacher: It’s their first time to come to China.Would you like to listen to their introductions?
Ss: Yes.(Three students can make introductions and act out the dialogue vividly.)
Step Three: Sum up.Some students are asked to sum up this lesson.It is how to make new friends and how to greet them.It is very important in the daily life.Homework
“How do you meet new visitors at home?
Period Two
课前准备
教师:准备歌曲磁带(歌词)、情景图片及上课所需表格。
学生:需要向父母了解自已名字的含义。
教学设计
Step One: Revise the sentence patterns.1.Sing an English song.(用唱歌的方式既带动了气氛,又复习了所学内容。)
Teacher: Yesterday we’ve known each other already.Do you remember your new friends’names? If you do, let’s sing the song “What’s your name?”.Hello!Hello!What’s your name? My name’s Gina.Hello!Hello!What’s his name? His name’s Peter.Hello!Hello!What’s her name? Her name’s Anna.2.Listen to the conversations and finish the exercises.Teacher: Yesterday I made a new friend.Her name is Jenny.She is very lovely.She introduces many friends of hers to me.Do you want to know about them? Let’s listen to the tape and find out some useful information.(Students listen to the tape and give the right answers.)
3.Act out the dialogues.(在特定的情景下表演对话更符合实际,更贴近生活。)
Teacher: Now you’ve known something about introductions and greetings.But if you are in other places, how do you introduce yourself and greet others? Look at the four pictures and imagine you are in such a situation, how do you get to know new friends?
(Students can choose any picture they like and act out the dialogues.)
Example:
(At a party)
Sa: Hello!I’m Lucy Green.What’s your name?
Sb: My name is Kate Brown, Jim’s classmate.Nice to meet you.Sa: Nice to meet you, too.I’m Jim’s sister.Welcome to Jim’s birthday party.Make yourself at home.Sb: Thanks, I will.Step Two: Choose English names.1.Play a name game.(有效引出“英文名字”这一主题。)
Teacher:As we know, everyone has a name.Each name has its special meaning and so do English names.Do you want to have an English name? If you do, let’s play a name game.The winners of the game will get English names.Rules: Every student should introduce himself or herself,but at the same time he(she)should repeat all the above-mentioned classmates' names.Example:
S1: My name’s Tony.S2: His name’s Tony.My name’s Linda.S3: His name’s Tony.Her name’s Linda.My name’s Nick.S4: His name’s Tony.Her name’s Linda.His name's Nick.My name's Kim.S5:…….2.Choose English names.1).Find out first names and last names.(用小组的方式完成名字的识别。)
Teacher: Congratulations to the winners.Now you choose English names from the box.But before you choose names, you must know English names have two parts: first name and last name.Look at the box, can you classify them according to the demands?
Jenny Gina Alan Mary Jim Tony Tom Bob MikeGreen Miller Jack Smith Brown Linda Nick Kim HandPeriod Three
课前准备
教师:准备所需的歌曲磁带、名片样本及各项表格。
学生:制作名片所需的纸张、画笔等。
教学设计
Step One: Present the English numbers.1.Sing the song “Ten Little Indian Boys”.(歌曲欢快有趣,比起单纯教授单词更为有效。)
Teacher: During the first two classes, we’ve known something about new friends names.But if we want to contact them.What shall we do?
S1: A telephone call.T: But you don’t have their telephone numbers.S1: Ask for their telephone numbers.T: If we want to know about their telephone numbers, we must learn how to say these numbers in English.Let’s learn to sing “Ten Little Indian Boys”.Words
One little, two little, three little Indisns,Four little, five little, six little Indians,Seven little, eight little, nine little Indians,Ten little Indian boys.(After singing the song, tell the students not to forget “zero”.)
T: Count the number together from zero to nine.S2: Zero…
2.Listen to the conversation and write the telephone number.(通过听力复习单词。)
Teacher: This is my friend’s telephone number.But I can’t hear it uld you please help me write it down?
(Students listen to the recording of 1b in Section B and give the answer.)
Step Two: Drills.1.Make a survey about your partners’ telephone numbers.(调查组内成员的电话号码,重点练习所学句式。)
Teacher: Thank you for your help.But do you want to know your friends’ telephone numbers? Now let’s make a survey about it and try to fill in the chart.
NameTelephone numbersLi LeiLiu Yu
Lin Fang
Yin Kailin
S1: Hello, Liu Yu.What’s your telephone number?
S2: My telephone number is …
S1: Oh, thank you.What about yours, Lin Fang?
S3: It’s…
S1: … And may I know your phone number, Yin Kailin?
S4: …
S1: Thank you very much.Oh, I nearly forgot.My telephone number is…
2.Report it to the class.(After the survey, every group can choose a student to report the survey result to the class.)
Example:
My telephone number is… Liu Yu’s phone number is… Lin Fang’s telephone number is… Yin Kailin’ s phone number is…
3.Listen and match the names and telephone numbers.(制作电话号码簿这一任务能够大面积调动学生装的参与意识。)
Teacher: I will play the recording twice.The first time just listen.The second time, write the letter of the person’s telephone number in the space after that person’s name.(Students listen to the tape.)
T: Next, I’ll play the recording again.This time, fill in the missing numbers.(Students listen to the tape again.)
T: Can you find out whose telephone numbers they are ?
S:…
4.Make an address book.Teacher: The new term begins.Our class needs an address book to contact each other.Now we can put all the information together and then we can have our own address book.Pay attention to the address book headings “Names” and “Phone numbers”.Now work in groups of six and ask your group members “What’s his /her name? And What’s his/her phone number?”
Step Three: Make an ID card. some different ID cards to the class and try to enjoy them.(向学生展示不同种类的名片,一方面开阔学生眼界,一方面便于学生找出名片所含内容。)(引导学生有效搜集名片上的信息,提高学生的阅读能力。)
Teacher: Now our class has a very useful address book.We can use it to talk with others on the phone.But for most adults, ID cards are more important because they are easy to take along.What’s more, they are very enjoyable.Sometimes they can show the owners’ special personalities.Look at the ID cards below and try to enjoy them.Teacher: From the cards above, what can you find out ?
S1: It must have a person’s name…
S2: Sometimes it has a motto.T: Yes, It must have a person’s name, postcode, telephone number, home address and e-mail address.So if you have a chance to make an ID card, you must think about all the above.But before you make your card, first let’s learn how to get information from the card.It’s very important.2.Read the ID card and answer the questions.(提供参考信息,但允许学生创新。)
Teacher: Look!Here’s an ID card of my friend’s.Please look at it and find out some useful information about her.1.What’s her telephone number?
2.What’s her family name?
3.What’s her first name?
Homework
1.Students are asked to make ID Cards of their own.Demands: A.Useful information must be included.B.It can be designed as beautifully as possible.C.Students may show their own personalities if possible.2.Find out the information about the famous person.Period Four
课前准备
教师:准备评价表、名人图片和一张个人海报。
学生:准备好完成的名片参加展览。
教学设计
Step One: Make an ID card show. the ID cards to the students.Teacher: Yesterday all of you made some beautiful ID we’ll make a show here.Let’s enjoy it together and try to choose the best ones.2.Find the owner of the card.Teacher: The ID card show is over.All the cards are mixed together.I can’t find the owners.Who can help me?
S1:I can.(Show one of the cards to another students.)
S1:Excuse me, are you in...?
S2:Yes, I am.S1:What’s your telephone number?
S2:It’s...S1:Are you...?
S2:Yes, I am.S1:Here’s your ID card.S2:Thank you.(Teacher asks more students to find the owners of ID cards).Step Two: “Face to Face”.1.Play a guessing game.Teacher: ID cards are useful.But some persons’names are known to all the people.They are very famous.Now look at the pictures and guess their names.(The teacher shows some famous person’s pictures and students guess their names and give their answers.)
llect useful information.Teacher: These persons are very famous.But it’s better for us to know something else about them.Before class you’ve been asked to collect some information.Now let’s exchange it together.3.Report it to class.Each group can choose a student to give a report about their favourite person.The other students can ask him some questions in class.Example:
S1:This is Michael Jordan.He’s years old.He’s...He speaks...His birth place is...He is a famous...player.He’s a member of six Chicago Bulls championship teams.People like to call him “Air Jordan”.S2:Do you like Michael Jordan? Why or Why not?
S1:Yes, I like him very much because he’s so...S2:Do you want to be a basketball player like him?
S1:Of course I do.That’s my dream.Step Three: Make a poster about yourself.Teacher: Do you want to be famous all over the world?
First you must learn to show yourself.Now you have a chance to do that.Please try to make a poster about yourself.In your poster you should try to introduce yourself.(Students can write a passage about themselves.They can give some personal information.They can alse design the poster as well as they can.)
Homework
Students are asked to sun up this unit, especially about how to talk with others politely.
英语七年级上册课件 篇5
一.单元分析
本单元以家庭为话题,以家庭介绍为任务学习That’s my sister. These are my brothers. Who is she?等句型的使用。要求学生能够做到:
1.运用这些句型向别人介绍某人的能力和与人交际的能力;
2.能向别人介绍自己的家庭情况;
3.在珍视自己的家庭,珍爱亲情的同时,关心不幸家庭的同学,对他们做力所能及的帮助。
二.学情分析
学生在小学中已经学习过一些家庭成员称呼的知识,对于一些简单的称谓表达没有问题,但书写仍然是有问题的。同时,由于中西方文化的差异,中国家庭中的一些关系可能不好表达,老师需要做必要的补充。
另外,由于计划生育政策的施行,同学们的兄弟姐妹少了,这对于brother, sister的概念的表达可能有些不利。但是,中国是一个注重家庭的国家,本单元的学习会让学生了解不同国家的家庭结构间的不同。同时由于班级内可能有来自单亲家庭的同学,在授课时要注意保护学生,不要伤及学生的自尊,同时要注意培养学生的移情能力。
三.课时安排
四课时
四.教学过程
Period 1 (A1, 3a, B3)
I. Teaching Objectives
1. Knowledge Objectives:
(1) Expressions: sister, mother, father, parent, brother, grandmother, grandfather, grandparent, family, those, who, oh, these, those, they.
(uncle, aunt, cousin, niece, nephew, here, photo )
(2) Structure: That’s my family. Those are my parents. Who’s she? She’s my sister. Oh, and these are my brothers.
3) Grammar: The plural forms of the demonstrative pronouns.
2. Ability Objectives:
(1) Learn how to introduce the family.
(2) Get Ss to know the names of the various members of a family.
3. Moral Objectives: Father and mother, I love you!
II. Teaching Importance(focus)
(1) Learn how to introduce the family.
(2) Get Ss to know the names of the various members of a family.
(3) Get Ss to know the differences between this/that is and these/those are.
(4) Get Ss to know who questions
III. Teaching Difficulties
1. 因为单复数的问题,学生对this与these,that与those的转换可能会弄错,
2. 在拼写时,学生习惯把mother写成monther。
3. grandmother,grandfather中d不发音。
Ⅳ. Teaching Aids
A recorder, multi-media
Ⅴ. Teaching Procedure:
Step l:Lead in
Enjoy an English song called the Finger Family, do daily greetings as usual.
Step 2: Pre-task
1. T: Today I’ll introduce a new friend.
Then show a picture of a boy to teacher new words about family members.
2. Work on 1a, match the words.
3. Listening practice: Do A 1b, first listen and circle the words, then imitate.
4. Look at the picture on SB P7, ask and answer in pairs.
Step 3:While-task
Photo show. 1.T ask and S answer
2. Ss ask and answer in pairs. Then Do A3a
3. Make a short passage about the photo. Then Do B 2b.
step 4:Post-task
Draw a photo of family and write about it, then share with friends.
Step 4. Sum up
Do exercises in class and check the answers
Homework
1.完成2号本P14-15 第一课时
2. 预习Unit 2 第二课时
3. 完成 Self check 2
4. 常规听读,听写作业
Layout of Bb
Unit 2 This is my sister. Period 1
sister, mother, father, parent, brother, grandmother, grandfather, grandparent, family, those, who, oh, these, those, they.
That’s my family.
Those are my parents.
Who’s she?
She’s my sister.
Oh, and these are my brothers.
教学反思:
Period 2 (A2)
I. Teaching Objectives
1. Knowledge Objectives:
(1) Expressions: well, have, day, bye, goodbye
(2) Structure: Have a good! Thanks! You, too. Bye!
— Nice to meet you. — Nice to meet you, too
(3) Grammar: Yes or No questions.
2. Ability Objectives:
(1) Identifying people and the relationship.
(2) Find out the correct relationship.
英语七年级上册课件 篇6
Unit 4 Where’s my schoolbag?说课稿 第一课时(Section A 1a-1c)
说课教师 :Crystal 大家好!
今天我说课的内容是人教版新目标英语七年级上册的第四单元Unit 4 Where’s my schoolbag?下面,我将从以下几个方面进行说课。
一、说教材
本单元主要内容是谈论物品的位置。通过询问物品的位置,学生们将学习一些有关家居物品的单词,以及on、in、under等方位介词的用法,学习并掌握where引导的特殊疑问句及其答语。学习人称代词they的用法。使学生学会基本句型“Where’s/ Where’re..? It’s/ They’re on/in/under...”学会运用方位介词“on/in/under”来表达物品的位置。通过以上的学习,使学生学会运用听关键词、推测词意的学习策略,识别不同物品的位置。这样既能让学生了解自己的家居环境,热爱自己的家,又能促使学生通过想象来设计自己理想中的房间和对好的生活习惯的重新认识。
二、说学情
本课的对象是刚进初中不久的七年级新生,他们好动、好奇、好表现,有部分学生小学并没有学过英语,他们对英语有着极大的兴趣和好奇心。教师应该抓住这个有利因素,注重对学生学习英语兴趣的培养,保持他们强烈的好奇心和旺盛的求知欲。因此,教师在教学过程中要精心设计各种教学活动,积极采用新颖、丰富多彩的教学手段来激发学生的学习兴趣,用兴趣来激活他们的思维能力,唤起他们的学习注意力,进而充分调动学生的学习积极性和主动性,让他们积极参与到教学中去。另一方面要创造条件和机会,让学生有机会表现自己,享受成功的喜悦,从而增强他们对英语学习的自信心,在学习过程中发展综合语言应用能力。让他们真正成为一堂课的主人。七年级英语教学是整个初中英语教学的基础,让学生迈好英语学习的第一步,对培养学生学习英语的能力和促进学生的个性发展有着很大的帮助。
三、说教学目标 知识目标:
1、学习和掌握有关询问物品位置的句型:
Where’s my schoolbag? It’s on/in/under/behind/next to the chair.2、学习和掌握有关家具类的单词:table, bed, bookcase, keys,books , sofa ,chair ,schoolbag
3、学会三个方位介词的用法:on ,in , under 能力目标:学会询问物品的位置和确认物品的位置;能够运用所学知识进行简单的会话。
情感目标:培养爱整洁的习惯和帮助他人的优良品德。[述职报告之家 www.Ys575.coM]
四、说教学重难点 重点:
1、熟练拼写和运用家居物品名称:where, table, chair, bed, bookcase, sofa, chair, on, under等词。
2、通过使用方位介词“on/in/under”表达物品的位置及学习“Where……”和“It’s……的用法,使学生学会运用特殊疑问句和陈述句。难点:
Where问句和方位介词on,in,under的用法。
五、说教法
在整个教学过程中我采用情景教学法、多媒体辅助教学法、合作学习法、小组竞赛法、交际法和任务驱动式教学法等教学方法进行教学。通过设置一些情景,让学生自己完成任务来学习知识、掌握技能。这种方法对于培养学生分析问题、解决问题的能力,激发和维持学生的学习积极性等有着独特的优势。因此,在教学过程中,我所要求学生掌握的内容都是通过一个个任务来进行,由易到难,由简到繁,让学生在不知不觉完成任务的过程中学到知识以兴趣吸引人,以情感培育人,以评价激励人、以活动促进人。
六、说教学过程 Step1.Warming up T:Good morning, everyone!Ss: Good morning,Miss Zhan!T:How are you today? Ss: Fine, thinks.And you? T:I’m fine, too.Step2:Lead in Now, look at me.What’s this in English? Ss: It’s a pen.T:Very good.together, read twice.Step3:Teach the new words 通过图片展示来学习新单词,同时引出句型“Where’s my schoolbag? It’s…” T:Where’s the schoolbag? Ss:It’s under the table?(引导学生回答)T: Where’s the pencil box? Ss: It’s on the desk.T: Where’s the baseball? Ss: It’s in the drawer.根据1a图,引出复数句型。Where are …? They’re …? T:Where are the books ? Ss:They’re on the sofa ?(引导学生回答)T: Where are the keys? Ss:They’ re on the table.接着板书呈现句型,让学生对比这两个单复数句型的用法。Step4:Listening Practice 1b 播放1b部分的录音让学生听,引导学生写出所听到的单词的号码,完成1b部分的听力任务。Step5: Pair work 让学生小组合作共同探究完成1c部分口语交际的教学任务,学会运用“Where’s my schoolbag? It’s under the chair.” 的对话及方位介词“on/in/under/behind”目标句型来表达物品的位置。Step6: Guess Game 设计一个猜谜游戏,比如把不同的物体放在不同的位置,让学生来猜,在找寻物体的过程中来巩固今天所学的内容。Step7:Summary 教师带着学生总结本课重点学习了哪些词汇、句型。Step8:Homework 1.画出自己的小房间,为其中的物品标上英文,物品越多越好。2.抄写新单词和重点句型。
板书设计:
Unit4 Where‘s my schoolbag?
Word: Sentences:
table chair bed Where‘s my schoolbag? It’s under the chair.Sofa clock tape Where is his pencil? It is in his schoolbag.Desk pencil Where are the keys? Ss:They’ re on the table.where schoolbag Where are my books on in under behind.? They’re on the sofa
英语七年级上册课件 篇7
教材分析
教材内容:新目标初中英语七上Unit1My name is Gina page 1-2
教材处理:本单元的重点在于如何在一个新的场合下介绍自己和认识他人。让刚入学不久的初中新生用英语搭建起他们友谊的桥梁。学会用“What’s your name? / What’s her name? / What’s his name?”以及复习Starter U1-3 所学过的一些common English Greetings 来结识朋友。本课生词量不大,重点在于对学生的口语操练以及常用人名的熟悉。
学情分析
本单元的主题是熟识新伙伴,同时引导学生采用Practicing, Listening for specific information和Role playing的学习策略,学习一些新词汇,掌握一些重点句型,在小组合作学习的过程中,进一步促进学生之间的相互了解。
教学目标
知识与能力
采用Practicing, Listening for specific information和Role playing的学习策略,使学生学会打招呼和介绍自己、询问他人姓名的基本句型What’s your/his/her name?My/His/Her name is…。”培养学生结交新朋友的能力。
过程与方法
采用Practicing, Listening for specific information和Role playing的学习策略,利用教学图片或制作多媒体课件展开课堂Pair work; Group work的口语交际活动,询问他人姓名、查询电话号码,了解有关姓名的文化知识并制作个性名片。
情感态度价值观
该部分学习内容贴近学生的生活,谈论的主题是结交新朋友,进一步促进学生之间的相互了解,使学生在轻松、愉快的学习氛围中熟识新伙伴,增进友谊。
教学重点和难点
本单元的重点在于如何在一个新的场合下介绍自己和认识他人。让刚入学不久的初中新生用英语搭建起他们友谊的桥梁。学会用“What’s your name? / What’s her name? / What’s his name?”以及复习Starter U1-3 所学过的一些common English Greetings 来结识朋友。本课生词量不大,重点在于对学生的口语操练以及常用人名的熟悉。
教学过程
Step1: 课前热身:与学生互相问好,然后问答姓名,自我介绍、介绍他人。(黑板板书关键句型:What’s your name? / What’s her name? / What’s his name?及其回答。)
(学生回答状况不一致,有错误出现。但不能急着纠正。先让他们大胆互动,激发他们的兴趣,在互相的活动中,感受句型的使用。老师对状况在心里进行把握。)
Step2: 复习前面说学过的名词及句型;
1. Today, we will learn Unit1. My name is Gina. We know Gina is a girl’s name. First, let’s see something about Gina.(展示图片)
T: Look, this is Gina’s room, big and nice. What things can you see in her room?
S: I can see a/an clock, jacket, quilt, plant, ruler, lamp, trash bin…
T: Spell it, please.
(通过这一步骤,一是复习了前面所学的名词,也复习了前单元的句型。二是引入课文的Section A 1a 部分)
2. This is Gina’s classroom.(展示图片)
What things can you see in Gina’s classroom? Please write down.
Except for the things, we also can see many students in the classroom. They are talking with each other. (让学生熟悉第一单元的生词,并引导进入Step 3 )
Step3: 介绍人名以及对话操练:
1.Gina’s classmates: Jim, Mary, Alan, Jenny. They are making friends with each other.
Now, let’s listen how they are making friends.
2. listening, 让学生看课本,并对所听到的对话排序。
3. Pair work: Making friends with your partner.
让学生操练(What’s your name? I’m/My name is …)
Step4: Meet some new friends.
(导入“What’s her name? / What’s his name?)
1.Alice, Cindy, Grace, Helen, Eric, Frank, Bob, Dale;
(通过复习starter U1 所学的男名和女名, 向学生介绍如何询问第三方的姓名)
What’s her name? / What’s his name?
2. 巩固 “What’s her name? / What’s his name?“的句型,
呈现一些明星的图片,询问他们的姓名。
3. Group work: Know the students’ names in your group and make friends with them.
Step5: Listening: 课本section A, 2a,2b
listening
引导学生操练对话
Game: Quickly reaction.
Game2: Let’s guess!通过文字的描述,让学生猜“What’s her name? / What’s his name?”猜的过程中,通过激发学生的奇心,让学生不断地开口说“Her/His name is…?”然后逐渐的增加信息量,直至学生猜出真实得姓名。
Step6: Group work and report
1.教师演示:These famous people we referred are my good friends. His name is … Her name is … So , where are your friends?
2. 学生操练对话并做一个report
3. 让学生写一段自己编写的互相介绍的对话。读出来,互相学习。
Step: Homework:
1、制作名字表格,把男生女生的英文名字进行归类。
2、准备家人的照片带来,介绍自己的家人给同学。
板书设计
Unit1 My name is Gina.
What’s your name? her
What’s her name? name
What’s his name? what
学生学习活动评价设计
练习对话并模仿对话,结识班级的其他同学并学过的内容来做对话。 掌握好了重点句型和人称代词的用法。
英语七年级上册课件 篇8
一、教学设计思路
用真实衣物做道具模拟情境,帮助学生练习谈论物品的颜色和价格;配以图片、视频歌曲等多媒体手段,加深学生印象。
二、教学目标
(一)知识
1.掌握如何谈论物品的颜色和价格:Howmuchis/are…?It's/They're…dollars.black,white,red,green,blue,yellow
2.掌握衣物的名称:socks,T-shirts,pants,shorts,sweater,hat
3.掌握数字10-31
4.掌握购物礼貌用语:CanIhelpyou?I'lltake…Thankyou.You'rewelcome.
(二)能力
能够在生活中买必要的东西。
(三)情感
在生活中要应用礼貌用语。
三、教学重点
谈论价钱
四、教学难点
结合物品的颜色、数量等询问和回答价钱。
五、教学媒体
常见衣物;电脑;投影仪
六、教学过程
(一)巧妙导入
方法1:通过询问学生衣服的颜色复习颜色词汇,进而引出衣物的话题。
方法2:拿出不同种类的衣物引起学生注意,进入话题
以上就是出国留学网小编给各位朋友带来的七年级上册英语教案范文是怎样的?希望本文分享的英语教案范文能对各位朋友有所帮助!
英语七年级上册课件 篇9
一、说教材
1.教材分析
本课为听说教学课,教材内容围绕着询问职业展开,内容比较贴近日常生活,是学生比较关心的话题,易于激发学生的学习兴趣。仁爱版七年级上册的Unit3 Topic2 Section A 在本单元中起着总领下文的关键作用。本课通过谈论父母的职业,让学生从学会谈论各种职业中,掌握句型What does he/she/your…do?从而学会关心他人,同时使学生能够利用简单的英语询问职业,为下节课谈论工作的地点做铺垫。通过本课教学,进一步培养学生运用英语的能力,使学生体会到学习英语的快乐。
2.教学目标
【知识目标】
能记忆有关职业的词汇,掌握如何询问职业的句型。
【能力目标】
学生学会并能运用询问职业的句型进行对话。
【情感目标】
通过句型操练,灵活运用所学知识,谈论家庭成员及其工作,学会关心他人,热爱生活。
3. 教学重难点
重点:让学生学会关于职业的词汇,并在活动中运用单词、句型。
难点:运用询问职业的句型进行交流
二、说学情
学生年龄在12-14岁;
活泼好动,好奇心、求知欲强,喜欢展现自己;
已掌握常用的职业词汇,如teacher, student等;
具备一定的听说读写能力;沟通能力欠佳,注意力不集中。
英语七年级上册课件 篇10
各位老师:
大家好!今天我要说课的内容是新目标七年级英语上册第二单元Section A的前部分,题目是Is this your pencil ?其主要的内容是学会辨认物品的所有者这一话题。由于本单元具有两部分Section A和Section B。从本单元来说,本节课既是本单元的基本语言内容,又为本单元知识扩展和综合语言运用奠定坚实的基础。因此,上好Section A的前部分,既可让知识学习具有一定的延续性,又可为下面的教学做好铺垫,对完成本单元和今后的英语教学具有重要的意义。
重点、难点及处理对于Secttion A前部分的教学,我准备把对词汇的掌握和听力的理解作为重点,把结队活动的核心对话作为难点。这是因为我校地处农村,学生在英语学习方面没有一个好的语言氛围,也没有听力训练的条件,因此解决这一重点,能让学生进一步感受英语语言的美,体验知识间的相互应用、相互依存的联系,让学生充满自信,体验成就感和合作精神。
教学方法为达到以上的教育教学目标,根据英语“课标”中强调课程要从学生的学习兴趣、生活经验和认知水平出发,倡导体验、实践、参入、合作与交流的学习方式和任务型的教学途径,发展学生的综合语言运用能力,是语言学习的过程成为学生主动参与、勤于动脑,提高跨文化意识的过程。根据学校和学生的实际,我将在教学中利用实物,采用任务型教学模式,运用情景教学法,结合听说法、竞赛法,以循序渐进的方式来进行教学。
首先,采用听说法和实物来导入和呈现本届的基本词汇和句型,目的在于用师生、生生互动的方式,激活学生对所学知识的已有体验,使学生对重点词语的识记经过一个由形象思维到抽象思维的转化过程,增强学生的记忆效果。其次,采用任务型教学途径,在活动中以循序渐进法,连锁操练,运用实物提示,展开竞赛等方式来突破重点,培养学生综合语言运用能力。这样不仅激活了学生的主体意识,而且在活学活用知识的过程中,增强了学生学习的自信心,从而体验到成功的喜悦。
学法教法的选择固然重要,但学法也必不可少。我们都知道,学生的学习过程并不是孤立于课堂教学之中,应遵循学生的身心发展规律和学习规律,指导学生进行个性化的学习,让学生在活动与交流中产生个性化的体验。《课标》明确指出:“英语课程应面向全体学生,力求为每个学生的充分发展创造条件。教师在教学的过程中要倡导学生体验、实践、参与、合作与交流的学习方式,结合课改精神和我校的学情,在本节教学中我主要采用小组自由合作学习的方式,由不同层次的学生组合成4人一小组。因为这样的合作学习方式能突出以人为本的教育思想,符合教育的宗旨,使学生个人之间的竞争转化为小组之间的竞争,既有助于培养学生的合作精神,团队意识以及集体观念,又有助于培养学生的竞争意识与能力,在活动中体验合作成功的快乐,体验实现自我价值的幸福。
英语七年级上册课件 篇11
新目标英语七年级上册Unit5教学设计
原州四中
牛平平
核心提示:教材分析
1、教学内容 1)、词汇:have,soccer,ball,tennis racket,ping-pong ball,volleyball,basketball sport,bat,2)、语言结构:A、Do you have a ping-pong ball?Yes,I do。Do you have a ping-pon
教材分析
1、教学内容
1)、词汇:have,soccer,ball,tennis racket,ping-pong ball,volleyball,basketball,bat,2)、语言结构:A、Do you have a ping-pong ball?Yes,I do。Do you have a ping-pong bat?No,I don’t。
2、教材的地位及其作用
本单元的教学主要内容是:学习have的一般现在时的疑问式的肯定和否定回答,该话题与学生的日常生活紧密联系在一起,容易唤起学生的学习兴趣,这对于提高学生的综合能力很有帮助,特别是说的能力。
本单元仍在继续学习一般现在时,这是一个生活中离不开的时态,也是最基本的一个时态。新课程标准要求学生重点掌握一般现在时,这在英语中使用频率很高,学好这一时态的用法对以后其他时态的学习和交际有很大的帮助。
二、学生分析
学生现有的能力与已掌握的知识:
学生在已经学过词汇:What is this ? What is that? 句型: Where is…? It’s in / on / under/…
经过前面的学习学生已经积累了一定的词汇,掌握了一定的目标语,已经具备了一定的听说读写能力。
三、教学目标
1、语言知识
词汇:A、重点掌握表示有关各种运动球类的名词, 如basketball, soccer ball,so on
重点句型:? Do you have a TV? Yes,I do./No,I don’t.2、语言技能
1)、能看着图片说;Do you have a TV? Yes,I do./No,I don’t.3、学习策略
1)、利用老师所提供的图片卡片做出简单的判断。
2)、通过与同学交流,学会使用一般现在时的疑问形式及肯定和否定回答。
4、情感态度
1)通过各小组的对话练习培养学生的合作精神; 2)通过学习本单元,让学生之间能够用所学句型互相交流。
重点难点
1、Have 的一般现在时的疑问式用法;
2、Have的一般现在时的疑问句,及其肯定,否定回答;教学手段:采用多媒体教学。教学突破:Section A重在通过使用动词have对物品的所属进行提问和回答的交流式口语活动,学习由助动词do引导的一般疑问句的构成以及回答。教师要善于引导学生比较行为动词的疑问句和be动词的疑问句在构成和回答上的区别,通过大量和反复地操练以达到运用自如。
四、教学流程
一、第一教学环节:情景创设,导入新课 教师活动 学生活动
Section A主要内容是通过使用have对物品的所属进行提问和应答,来学会使用do引导的一般疑问句。所以在教学中可采取问答式导人法:
掌握新单词.采用各种方法学习单词。
1、升降语调、拼读、接龙和肢体的方式记忆单词。
2.检查学生记忆单词的成效。
3、学生看1a的图片,使字母和单词相对应。
第二教学环节;老师和学生互动:学习掌握重要内容。
教师活动 学生活动(看图片练句型)分片进行演示:I have a footba1 1.Do I have a football? 自己回答:Yes,I do. 再问:Do I have a basketball? 自己回答:No,I don’t.再使用其它物体和图片询问学生:Do I have…? 询问学生:Do you have…? 询问学生:…?
2.要求学生完成1b的听力,达到教学应完成的任务。
3.引导学生展开Pair work活动,完成lc部分口语交际的教学任务,学会运用助动词do进行问答,可采用师生互动带动学生互动的交流方式: 4.Pair work活动,完成lc部分口语交际的学习任务,学会运用助动词do进行问答并上台展示口语交际。
三、第三教学环节:合作交流,巩固提高
教师活动 学生活动
1、学生巩固练习活动,完成课堂练习和总结及笔头练习的教学任务。
2、让总结本课的 主要内容,如果不周到,教师可以补充完成。
英语七年级上册课件 篇12
初一年是初中的起始年段,是小学到初中的转折阶段,务必打好语音基础,学会科学地背单词,整体地理解句子,领会中西语言结构的不同。
语音基础,包括音标和字母,26个字母先学会,48个音素中的元音音素20个,其中单元音12个先学会。然后在第二个课时学会辅音音素中的10个成对出现的音素。希望能在第一个星期完成音标音素的学习。
第二周开始进入第一单元的学习。(还是在学习音标的同时学习音素?)
第一单元,主题是交朋友,topic 1是welcome to China. 功能是问候,介绍和说再见。理解be动词的用法。Topic 2是where are you from?功能是谈论名字,出生地和电话号码;语法是学会疑问句what/ where/ who的表述,理解人称代词的主格。Topic 3是How old are you ? 谈论年龄,班级,年级,辨认物品。语法还是学习疑问句what/ how,代词a/an的用法,名次的复数形式(plural)。
第二单元Unit 2, 主题是谈论外貌特征。Topic1是I have a small nose. 功能是描述外貌(appearances),语法学习一般现在时have/has的用法。Topic 2 是What does she look like? 功能是描述外貌、服饰、颜色,语法是wh-questions. Topic3 是Whose cap is it? 功能是谈论物品的归属性。语法是物主代词(possessive pronouns), 特别注意名词性物主代词(the possessive case of nouns)。
第三单元Unit3,主题是getting together,朋友家人的团聚。Topic 1 Does he speak Chinese?功能是学会发出请求(making requests), 交朋友(招待朋友), 表达爱好。语法是学习人称代词,以及一般现在时like / want/ speak 的用法。Topic 2 What does your mother do? 功能是谈论职业,说明家人的职业外貌等特征。语法是疑问句,学习work-worker单词的变形,一般现在时do/ does的用法。Topic3What would you like to drink? ,功能是一起吃饭,发出建议或请求。
第四单元Unit 4,主题是having fun, 一起玩得很高兴。 Topic1What can I do for you?功能是购物,谈论重量,以及发表建议。语法是疑问句how much/ how many的区别,some与any 的区别,可数名词与不可数名词。Topic2 Would you like to cook with us? 功能是打电话,邀请别人,发出建议,语法是复习一般现在时。Topic3是What time is it now?功能是谈论时间,谈论日常互动,语法是时间的表达。
虽然内容简单,但是对于初一部分没有真正学过英语的孩子来说是很难的。因此,要注意语言与功能相结合,提升学生的学习兴趣,提高学习效果。
本学期将继续关注以阅读与作文相结合的课堂一体化教学,使得学生养成英语阅读的习惯。有必要印发短小的英语文章,每周两篇,还是以新概念英语第一册做为辅助?
对学生的要求如下:1.课堂积极发言。2.做好课堂笔记。3.每篇课文要背诵。(利用微信群发到群里让大家一起听)4.单词小测要100分。错一个抄20遍。5.抄单词每个一行,每行8个单词或字母。
英语七年级上册课件 篇13
七年级上册英语第二单元This is my sister.说课稿
各位评委各位老师,大家上午好!我是……。今天,很荣幸能站在这里为大家呈现我的一堂课并接受大家的指点。接下来,我将从以下六个部分来阐述我的课程。
第一部分 说教材
今天我上课的内容是人教版新目标七年级英语上册第二单元This is my sister第一课时.本节课既是本单元的基本语言内容,又为后面知识的扩展和综合语言运用奠定坚实的基础。因此,上好本课时,既让知识的学习有一定的延续性,又为后面的教学做好铺垫,对完成本单元的英语教学具有重要的战略意义。另外,根据国家课程标准的要求,里面就有关于“家庭与朋友”的话题;课标还要求学生在中学毕业时要达到五级目标,而五级里也有关于“家庭、朋友与周围的人”的话题。可见“家庭”话题贯穿始终。本单元作为初中阶段对家庭话题的起始单元则更应该让学生掌握好最基本的介绍家人、确认人物的句式,为以后的学习打好基础。同时,家庭成员是学生最亲最熟悉的人,这个话题会给学生带来认同感和自信心,提高学生投入其中的兴趣。
1.教学目标
知识目标:
1).能正确使用家庭成员的称谓:mother, father, parent, grandfather, grandmother, grandparent, brother, sister.2).能正确使用介绍人物的句型:This / That is….These / Those are….3).能正确使用确定人物的句型:Who is he/ she? He /She is….Is she / he/ this/ that…? Yes,she/ he/it is.No, she/ he/it isn’t.4).能发现名词单数和复数形式的不同,能在对话中开始有意识地使用名词的复数形式,以及搭配一致的谓语。
能力目标:
1).能听懂介绍人物和确定人物的句型的对话。
2).能用家庭成员称谓以及介绍人物和确定人物的句型来看图说话和两两对话。
3).能用目标句型角色扮演和续写对话。
情感目标:
能意识到家庭成员和朋友是自己一生的财富,要懂得珍惜。教学重点
1).掌握本课时表示家庭成员称谓的单词。
2).能正确使用介绍人物的句型:This / That is….These / Those are….3).能正确使用确定人物的句型:Who is he/ she? He /She is….Is she / he/ this/ that…? Yes,she/ he/it is.No, she/ he/it isn’t.教学难点
1).能发现名词单数和复数形式的不同,能在对话中正确地使用名词的复数形式,以及搭配一致的谓语。
2).在this/that作主语的疑问句中,正确地用it指代回答。
第二部分 说学情
初一学生对英语既陌生又感到新鲜好奇,他们希望通过学好这门新课程来提高整体知识水平或得到他人的认可,并渴望将英语用到生活中来增加乐趣。但由于学习态度和学习习惯的不同,随着英语学习内容的增加,两级分化开始出现。唤醒学生的兴趣,增强他们的自信心,小组合作学习显得尤为重要。同时,还要适度拓展知识,满足优等生的需要。
第三部分 说教法
“新课标”强调课程要从学生的学习兴趣、生活经验和认知水平出发,倡导体验、实践参与、合作和交流的学习方式和任务型的教学途径,发展学生的综合语言运用能力,根据本班学生情况,我将在教学中利用简笔画,多媒体等,采取任务型教学模式,运用情景教学法,结合听说法、contest guessing、小组合作,循序渐进进行教学,激发学生的兴趣,培养学生综合运用语言的能力,学以致用。
教学用具:简笔画,多媒体课件,录音机
第四部分 说学法
1、合作学习。本课时将在课堂活动中将学生分成六人一组的学习小组,在活动中互相交流、互相探讨,相互合作,从而获得知识、技能和情感体验,发展他们的能力。
2.主动学习。通过创设情境和有意义的任务活动,激发学生的学习热情,发挥他们自己的主观能动性,把被动学习变为主动学习。
第五部分 说流程 Step 1.Warning up
首先,用所学的How are you?来进行简单的问候,这样既把学生带入到英语学习的环境又巩固了所学知识。然后,将学生的注意力吸引到屏幕上,介绍这是我的朋友,这些是我的朋友们。friend是已学内容,能够明白。然后出示我的图片问学生Who is she,学生回答是我,然后说你们知道了我的好朋友,想不想见见我的家人的照片呢,今天我就来将我的家人介绍给大家,学习完这堂课,同学们下次就能用英语将你的家人朋友介绍给别人啦,由此引入标题This is my sister.Step 2.Presentation
呈现“父亲”图片,介绍“This is my father.”同时将这句话板书在黑板上。带学生拼读这个单词的音标,然后F-A-T-H-E-R,father这样领读这个单词。然后以同样的方式呈现“That is my mother.”“These are my parents.””This is my grandmother.””That is my grandfather.””Those are my grandparents.””This is my brother.””That is my sister.”将新单词写在黑板左边,句子结构This/That is...,These/Those are...写在黑板中间。
然后请同学们以开火车的方式翻译刚刚出现过的单词,教师进行及时更正。
接下来进行反馈。让八个学生举手扮演教师本人,来对刚刚出现的图片用This/That is...,These/Those are...进行介绍.这样初步了解学生对单词的掌握情况,及初步接触使用目标语言。
然后分组比赛,将全班学生分为ABC三大组,和教师进行英汉互译游戏,教师说一个单词,学生起立翻译,第一个站起来翻译正确的学生可为本组争取一分。这样可以极大调动全班学生的积极性,同时巩固了单词。然后,教师一张一张出示单词卡片,教师点名翻译,这样来检验后排的学生是否掌握了单词。翻译对的学生加一分。
接下来到了课本内容环节。“同学们,现在你们已经知道了我的家人,而且还知道家庭成员的英语称谓啦,你们看,这是Dave,你们知道他的家人分别是哪个吗?”由此过渡到活动1a。“请看图,who is Dave’s mother?”学生说字母a,”是的,所以我们把字母a写在mother后面的横线上。”请同学们将其他单词和图片配对,这个环节学生独立完成。教师在班内走动,了解学生的进度并提供必要的帮助。然后,核对答案。
然后,指着图片介绍“Dave is introducing his family to his friend, Linhai.让我们来听一听他们的对话内容,并帮忙圈出他所介绍的人吧!”播放录音机,第一次,请同学们认真听,不写,第二次,请同学们完成任务。然后请一个学生说出他的答案,再播放录音一次,和全班学生一起核对答案。最后,请同学们打开课本69页,跟读录音一遍,要求注意语音语调。然后把学生的注意力吸引到语法上,强调目标语言的句子结构及单复数。
Step 3.Practice
“接下来我们来看看1c中的对话,聪明的同学们发现这个对话和图片中的对话有什么联系吗?”“是的,他们就是同一个对话。”“我们回顾一下,这个对话和刚才录音中的对话有什么联系吗?”“是的,这个对话就是录音中对话的一部分。”“让我们全班齐读一遍。”全班齐读。然后请两个学生扮演Dave和Lin Hai示范读一遍。接着,请同学们二人一组进行练习,并轮流介绍1a图片中的其他成员。最后,请三组同学说出他们的对话。
接下来,实践练习部分。教师出示自己画的家庭简笔画,对自己的家庭成员进行介绍,然后请同学们画各自的简笔画,然后介绍给小组成员。这个环节画简笔画部分需要两分钟有点难以掌控,但会非常有趣,同时让学生增加对家人的认识。最后邀请两个学生带着简笔画向全班介绍。
Step nsolidation
将学生的注意力吸引到屏幕上。“我们来做一个猜一猜的游戏,这个女孩是玲玲,猜一猜她在和谁说话呢?”同时板书句型“Who is that?””Is that her...”在黑板上。这个环节只有两个图片,学生会有一种意犹未尽的感觉,借用这个感觉将它布置为家庭作业,请同学们一个扮演玲玲,拿着照片对话,另一个学生来猜。
Step 5.Summary
“是的,玲玲和她的家庭玩得很开心。那么,请同学们想一想,什么是family?”请学生思考,帮助找出答案。然后播放背景音乐《相亲相爱的一家人》,介绍自己怯于介绍自己父亲的故事,引导学生思考“不要想家人为你做了什么,想想你为家人做了什么”,进行感情引导,任何时间任何场所都要勇敢自信地介绍自己的家人,因为他们是我们最重要的人。同时,也要珍惜身边的亲人朋友。今天我们学习了家庭成员的称谓,及如何介绍他人。
Step 6.Homework
课后和同学完成刚才那个猜一猜的游戏,并预习下一课时内容。
第六部分 板书设计Blackboard Design
Unit 2 This is my sister.father, mother, parents,grandfather,grandmother,grandparents,brother,sister
--This/That is...--These/Those are...--Who is he/she?
--He/She is...--Is she/he/this/that...?
--Yes, she/he/it is...No,she/he/it is...
英语七年级上册课件 篇14
人教版英语七年级上册
Unit7 How much are these socks?
Section A(1a-2e)湛江市霞山职业高级中学 蔡景茜
一、教材分析
本节课是新目标英语七年级上册unit 7 How much are these socks?第一课时,以Shopping为主线,通过对本课的学习,让学生学会用英语谈论服装的颜色、尺寸和价格,学生运用所学语言,模拟在商场售货和购物。教学内容简单且富有生活情趣,有利于激发学生的参与意识和好奇心理。
二、教学目标 1.知识目标:
词汇:掌握有关服装、尺寸和颜色的单词 句型:(1)--How much is …?--It’s….(2)--How much are …?--They’re….2.能力目标:学会询问价格及使用购物用语
3.情感目标:树立节约用钱合理消费的正确消费观念 学习重点:学会使用询问价格的句型,并能正确回答 学习难点: 区分服装的单复数
三、学情分析
抓住七年级学生活泼、好动、好胜心强的特点,引进小组竞争机制,倡导其参与活动。在教学中努力营造宽松、民主、和谐的教学氛围,鼓励他们大胆尝试,保护他们的自尊心和积极性。
四、教法分析
1.情景引入法:利用多媒体创设情景,引入新知识,吸引学生注意力,使他们对即将学习的新知识产生好奇。2.听说法:对目标语言进行反复操练,以达到灵活运用的目的。
3.任务型教学法:设计一系列的任务活动,让学生在完成任务的过程中掌握目标语言。
五、学法分析 1.分组合作学习。
2.‚为用而学,用中学,学了就用‛:本课时的目标语言是询问物品的价格,与学生实际生活联系紧密,所以应该充分利用创造的情景和实物给与学生练习英语口语的机会。
六、教学过程 Step1 Warming up Show a picture T: I’m very happy these days because Nov 11 online shopping carnival is coming soon.I want to buy a lot of clothes.Can you help me put them into the shopping cart? 【设计意图】通过双十一购物狂欢节引入新课,使学生在欢快自然的气氛中不知不觉进入教学,激发他们的兴趣和热情,活跃课堂气氛,并为本课任务的开展做热身准备。Step 2 Presentation 1.Present the new words about the picture of a sweater T: Look!What’s this?
Ss: It’s a sweater.In the same way, learn the other new words about clothes.Match the words with the things in the picture, and then check the answers together.2.Present the words about size: big, small, long, short.3.Present the words about colors.4.Present the monetary unit of yuan and dollar 【设计意图】通过大量的图片引入,直观地呈现新单词,能吸引学生的注意力,活跃学生的思维,激起学生的求知欲,让学生在真实的语境中理解单词。Step 3 Listening 1.Listen to the conversations and circle the things you hear, and then check the answers.2.Listen again and fill in the price tag, and then check the answers.【设计意图】通过师生互动的方式,引导学生看书上的六幅插图,听音圈物品,核对答案;再听录音,填价签,通过这项操练,锻炼学生获取信息的能力,在听力中使用目标语言,为下一个任务做准备。Step 4 Practice 1.Present the new sentence patterns: ‚How much is /are…? It’s/They’re …‛
2.Get the students to practice the dialogues in pairs.【设计意图】通过呈现询问价格的句型,让学生总结‚How
much is / are…? It’s / They’re…‛ 的特点:单数用is ,复数用are,并通过结对操练加以巩固。Step 5 Read and act 1.Let the students try to fill in the blanks in the conversation, read and act it out.2.Translate the sentences into English.【设计意图】通过补充对话中所缺的单词和句子,进一步熟悉购物时所需的交际用语,为下一任务做准备。Step 6 Consolidation Scene play: Thanksgiving Day is coming, please buy some clothes for your friends.【设计意图】通过‚shopping‛这个生活平台,学生不仅可以在愉快的氛围中运用本节课所学询问价钱等语言,而且使学习的过程变得生动有趣,这一活动将课堂气氛推向高潮。Step 7 let’s be a doctor Get the students to correct some wrong sentences.【设计意图】通过易错点的呈现和改正,学生能更好地掌握知识点。
Step 8 Summary and Homework 1.Summarize what we have learned in this lesson 2.Homework: write a dialogue about shopping 【设计意图】通过鼓励学生小结本课的收获,培养他们自主学习的习惯。本作业与本节课的教学目标相匹配,既帮助学生巩固了已学语言材料,又提高学生写作的能力。
教师用一长一短的pants和shorts呈现long和short,用一大一小的sweater呈现big和small, 并让学生跟着老师做手势。
[教学思路] 通过猜图游戏引入,能吸引学生的注意力,活
跃学生的思维,激起学生的求知欲,使学生能愉快地参与课堂活动,用实物和肌体语言,直观地呈现big,small , long and short等形容词,让学生在真实的语境中理解单词。Show some pictures, get the students to practice the new sentence patterns: ‚How much is / are…? It is / They are…‛ Step3、教授、练习新句型,完成活动1c 将dollar与人民币单位yuan相比较,注意dollar的单复数变化。
此环节中结合图片设计师生对话、结对活动、小组活动等任务,让学生分小组竞赛,练习巩固新句型。在练习的过程中,将重点句型How much is it?发散为How much are they?重点掌握单复数在此句型中的变化。Step4.综合运用
How much is that red hat? It’s 6 dollars.How much are your white trousers?
They are 10 dollars.加大句子难度继续操练,巩固新词汇和句型。
此环节将表示颜色的形容词带入操练句型中,并结合学生穿的毛衣、裤子、身边的尺子、书包、铅笔、橡皮擦擦等物品让学生自己编对话。
Step5、总结回顾
1、词汇:T-shirt, sweater, skirt, jacket, socks, shoes, trousers, shorts
2、句型:--How much is this T-shirt?--It’s 7
dollars.--How much are these socks?--They are 2 dollars.Homework: Ask about prices of your friend’s clothing, and write down your conversations.询问你朋友衣物的价格,并将你们的对话写下来。Step6、板书设计
Unit 7 How much are these socks?(Section A 1a ~2d)Clothing jacket A: How much is this T-shirt? a pair of socks B: It’s seven dollars.two pairs of trousers A: How much are these socks? Shorts shoes skirt sweater
B: They are two dollars.(一)教材分析
本节课是义务教育课程标准实验教科书英语新目标‚Go for it‛七年级上册unit 7 How much are these pants?的第一课时。本节课是新课引入,教学内容和教学重点就是通过学习section A(1a—2c),认识并初步掌握谈论衣物,询问价格这一情景中的运用。教学内容简单且富有生活情趣,有利于激发学生的参与意识和好奇心理,更主要的是学生通过对本课的学习,让学生学会用英语谈论服装的颜色和价格,学
生运用所学语言,可以模拟在商场售货和购物。第一课时的引入在整个单元中起到了抛砖引玉的作用,同时也是一座桥梁,是正确引导学生由说到写的第一步。因此,本节课的教学重点就落在反复熟练地运用语言上,通过大量的口头交际,为第二课的教学做好扎实的准备。
(二)教学目标
根据新课标的教学理念,从素质教育的要求出发,结合本课的教学内容和学生的语言水平,本节课的核心任务是让学生学会用英语谈论服装的颜色和价格,并可以模拟在商场里售货和购物。学生要达到以下五个目标:
语言知识目标:掌握本课书的重点词汇、语言结构。
语言技能目标:学会谈论衣服的名称,颜色和价格。
情感态度目标:通过创设人文情景,学生亲自感受和体验,使语言学以致用,激发学生的学习积极性,培养他们的自主学习,合作学习,善于学习的习惯,并让他们在实践活动中体验成功。
学习策略目标:能对所学内容主动练习和实践,提高合作意识和自主学习能力。
文化意识目标:培养学生实际运用英语能力,使学生进一步
明白语言也是文化,扩展他们的文化视野,增强他们的跨文化交际的意识和能力。学生上完本节课后,学会用英语谈论服装的颜色和价格。
(三)学生分析
①初一学生有着学习英语的浓厚兴趣和愿望,乐于参与多种调查、采访、表演等实践活动。到学期后段,学生已具备了一定的英语基础,并在unit 5 Do you have a soccer ball?和unit 6 Do you like bananas?中进行过有关调查活动、设计过野炊菜单、外出活动安排表;有过寻宝、建立俱乐部、给父母准备生日礼物等英语实践活动的体验。
②本班大部分学生有较为明确的英语学习动机和积极主动的学习态度,能积极和他人合作,相互帮助,共同完成学习任务。有不少学生表达较艰难,因此,在位置安排上,应把他们平均分配到各组,让好的学生带动他们学习,设计任务时应易到难、难易适中,教师在活动过程中经常跟他们交流,给予帮助和鼓励。
(四)设计理念
为了每位学生的发展是课程改革的核心。在本课中一共设计了三个任务:‚从认识物品‛到‚谈论价格‛,再到‚现场购物‛实现了由浅入深,由已知到未知,由知识向能力的过渡,让学生在活动中学英语。同时也着重于能力的培养和思维的
扩展,如小组合作能力、口头表达能力等。通过作业的布置,使课堂内外任务相随,能有效提高学生的英语水平,特别是培养学生的语言运用能力和动手能力。
孩子们是教育的重要资源、是动力之源、能源之库。本节课主要依靠学生,让学生进行自主学习,由于孩子们爱表现自己,通过现场购物这一任务,让孩子们学会创新、学会配合,连成绩不好的孩子也会大大方方地说上几句英语,这一活动将课堂气氛推向最高潮,孩子们学到了知识,急于即时运用。让孩子们在实际语言材料中感知,在课堂上享受着学习的快乐。
(五)教学过程
根据任务型教学模式,我将教学过程设计如下:
Step 1 Warming up
(Two minutes)
1、Sing an English song.2、Greetings.Who is wearing yellow today? Yellow today , yellow today.Who is wearing yellow today? Yellow today.①Black
②White
Green
⑤Blue
③Red
④[教学思路]通过Sing a song of color 引入新课,使学生在欢快自然的气氛中不知不觉进入教学,激发他们的兴趣和热情,活跃课堂气氛,并为本课任务的开展做热身准备。
Step 2 Presentation
(Seven minutes)
1、present the new clothing words.T: Boys and girls , I thought LingShui is very hot.But today it is cold , you see , I am just in a blouse now.I feel so cold.What should I do ? Oh, I must go to the shop to buy some clothes.教师布置任务:What am I going to buy ? Can you guess?
学生回答:毛衣∕裤子。
(逐渐展示毛衣的完整图片)
T:Oh!It is a sweater.Read after me ‘‘sweater‛.Ss: ‘‘Sweater‛.(Then show another picture with a boy and a woman come to the clothes shop ,What are they going to buy ?Can you guess?)
T:(Pointing to the boy)
What is LiLei going to buy ?
Ss: 裤子、短裤、短袜和鞋子。
T: Excellent!He is going to buy pants, shorts, socks and shoes.Read after me ‘‘pants ,shorts, socks and shoes‛.Ss:
‘‘Pants , Shorts, Socks and Shoes‛.T:
(Pointing to the woman)
What about his Chinese teacher Miss Li ?
Ss: She is going to buy a sweater and a T—shirt.T: It is very clever of you to say so!
2、Present: big , small, long, short.教师用一长一短的pants和shorts呈现long和short,用一大一小的sweater呈现big和small, 并让学生跟着老师做手势。
[教学思路] 通过猜图游戏引入,能吸引学生的注意力,活跃学生的思维,激起学生的求知欲,使学生能愉快地参与课堂活动,用实物和肌体语言,直观地呈现big,small , long and short等形容词,让学生在真实的语境中理解单词。
Step 3 practice and present‚How much is /are…? It is/They are …‛。(Six minutes)
1、教师先通过多媒体呈现短裤、男衬衣、毛衣等图片,鼓励学生说出相应物品的名称,由复习衣物名称导入How much is/are ……? It is /They are 等句型。
T:(Pointing to the sweater)What is this in English ?
Ss: It is a sweater.T: What color is it ?
Ss: It is red.T: How much is the red sweater ?
Ss: …(学生可能不知所云,教师快速点击鼠标,一张8元人民币的价签已挂在毛衣上。)
T:It is 8 Yuan , Read after me ‚It is 8 yuan‛.Ss:‚It is 8 Yuan..‛
T:You are so intelligent , and I think it is 3 dollars.(教师快速点击鼠标,挂上3美元的价签,从而引出生词dollar.)
教师教读几遍后,快速在裤子、短袜、鞋等服装上挂上价签,反复让学生练习How much is…? It is…的句型。
2、教师通过多媒体呈现两件挂有7美元价签的pants和三件挂有9美元价签的shorts问学生,由教‚How much is…? It is…‛过度到教‚How much are…? They are…‛.T:How much are these pants?
Ss:They are seven dollars.学生回答时可能想不到dollar需加s ,教师可通过dollar 与 yuan的货币学习,讲解人民币和美元的不同写法及用法,并简单介绍汇率的概念。
[教学思路]通过鼓励学生说出相应的衣物名称引出目标语言‚How much is are…?It is / They are…,‛产生信息沟,学生有交流的动机和兴趣,兴趣是最好的老师,在新课
呈现时,以兴趣为出发点,通过图片及信息沟激发学生的兴趣。同时,在特定的语境中引出生词dollar ,做到了‚词不离句‛让学生有意义地学习单词。
Step 4 Group work(Six minutes)
①T:I like shopping very much.Do you like shopping? Now come with me to the clothing shop again.Go over how to say them in English and how to buy them.Boys and girls , are you ready? Ss:Ok.T:This is a sweater.(学生重复说a sweater ,并用手拼写sweater.)
T:What color is it?
Ss:It is red.(并用手拼写red)
T:How much is the red sweater?
Ss:It is eight dollars.通过实物图,教师提问,学生集体回答,由单数名词到复数名词,反复操练新句型。
②Then , students play a guessing game:
T:How much is the red sweater /are the white shoes ?
Can you guess?
Ss:Is it /Are they 3 dollars?
T:No , it is / they are move expensive / cheaper.Well done!You are right.[教学思路]利用多媒体动画,给学生提供明确,真实的语言信息,把表示衣物名称、颜色、大小、长短的新单词和句型‚How much is / are…? It is / They are…‛融合在一起进行操练。接着,考虑到学生有一定的基础,如果单纯看图机械操练,虽使用了target language ,但学生兴趣不大,仍是无意义操练,于是设计了‚猜衣物价格‛游戏,极大地调动了学生的积极性和主动性,也使本课教学目标中的重、难点得到进一步的巩固。
Step 5 Listening(Seven minutes)1、1c练习对话
先让学生齐读1c,接着让学生分组角色,变换角色,反复运用衣物名称、颜色、大小、长短的新单词和句型进行自由操
练,然后教师检查几组同学的操练情况,目的是保证他们能正确而迅速地说出新语言,最后总结句型‚How mach is / are…? It is / They are…‛ 的特点:单数用is ,复数用are.2、2a,听对话,圈出你听到的物品。3、2b,再听一遍录音并填写价签。
[教学思路]通过师生互动的方式,引导学生看书上的六幅插图,复习服装名称及‚How much is / are…?‛句型,然后听音圈物品,核对答案;再听录音,填价签;第三遍听录音,写出对话中衣物颜色及名称的单词,通过这项操练,锻炼学生获取信息的能力,在听力中使用目标语言,为下一个任务做准备。
Step 6 Consolidation(Ten minutes)
任务活动:赠送生日礼物
教师创设情景:今天是Ann的生日,她的几位好朋友要去购买服装、鞋帽作为礼物送给她,5分钟内,看哪小组购买的服装最经济实惠。学生从小组为单位,模拟在商场购物。
①教师先和一名学生一道示范对话。
②学生四人一组,自己编对话表演,教师巡视帮助解决困难。
③成果汇报以给过生日的同学赠送生日礼物的形式呈现,并评出最佳小组。
[教学思路]通过‚shopping‛这个生活平台,学生不仅可以在愉快的氛围中运用本节课所学询问价钱等语言,而且使学习的过程变得生动有趣,这一活动将课堂气氛推向最高潮。
Step 7 Summary and Homework(Three minutes)
①先以小组为单位进行讨论,总结出这节课有什么收获,学会了什么,作自由发言。
②教师呈现本节课的重点内容。
③在布置家庭作业时,教师设计了一个简单的书面练习,课后写一段购物活动中的对话,以巩固本节课的语言知识。
④教师用一句Are you happy ? 来了解学生在这节课上开心与否来做为评价方式,让学生在愉快的气氛中结束学习。
[教学思路]通过鼓励学生小结本课的收获,培养他们自主学习的习惯。本作业与本节课的教学目标相匹配,既帮助学生巩固了已学语言材料,又提高学生写的能力。
Yjs21.Com更多幼师资料扩展阅读
七年级英语上册课件集锦
幼儿教师教育网花费大量时间和心血把资料整合成了这篇“七年级英语上册课件”,感谢您的浏览。老师会对课本中的主要教学内容整理到教案课件中,又到了老师开始写教案课件的时候了。教案是教育教学工作中的“先决条件”必须得到充分重视。
七年级英语上册课件 篇1
Unit1 Topic 2 Where are you from?
学习目标:
1.学习数字0-10 及短语zero, one, two, three, four, five, six, seven, eight, nine, ten ,telephone, number
What’s his telephone number?
His telephone number is (010)8267-6790.
3.了解单词音节和重音。做到语音正确。
2. (朗读句子,并标出语调,巩固be from在不同人称的应用,复习国家名称。) Step2 问题导学 A.选择最佳答案
( )1 —Are they from Canada? —No, they ____.
( )2. —What’s ____ telephone number?
—It’s 8265-3412.
( )3. —____ are they? —They are XiaoLi and Jane.
( )4.. Mary ____ from Cuba.
( )5. “One one zero” 表示 ____。
( )6.. —Is he Li Ping? —Yes, ____.
1. —W____ are you from? 2. —What’s y____ name? —I’m from Shanghai. —My name is David.
3. —Are you f____ Zhengzhou? —No, we aren’t.
4. —What’s your telephone n ?—It’s (010)8659-7981.
5. —E me, are you Frank? —Yes, I am.
2. (师连续读出这11个数字,强调前10个数字用升调,最后一个用降调,并要求学生跟读,培养学生语感。)
3.(做出打电话的动作,理解telephone number的意思。)
T:What’s your telephone number?
1— W____ is he? —He i____ Xiao Ming.
2. —Is she ____ Japan? —No, she ____.
3. —W ____ are they from? —They are from C____.
4. —What’s y____ QQ number?
—____ QQ number is 158141028.
5. —____ she Jane? —____, she is.
What’s your telephone number? My telephone number is
What’s his telephone number?His telephone number is
( ) 6. How old are you?
( ) 7. Where are you from?
( ) 8. What’s your telephone number?
( ) 9. Is Miss Yang your English teacher?
( ) 10. Glad to meet you.
B.用适当的词填空。 Hello! My 1 is Kangkang. 2 am from China. This 3 my friend. 4 is his name? His name is Mike. 5 is from the U.S.A. His phone 6 is (010)6534-8719. Miss Zhao 7 my teacher. 8 is she from? She is from China, 9 . She is fine. 10 telephone number is (010)6534-8897.
1. ___________ 2. ___________ 3. ___________ 4. ___________
5. ___________ 6. ___________ 7. ___________
9. ___________ 10. ___________ 8. ___________
七年级英语上册课件 篇2
电子课件就是全部输入在电脑中的,通常也都是教师自己上课所背的内容。这里讲的教案与传统上的有很大的不同,下面为大家分享了七年级上册英语的电子课件,欢迎借鉴!
1.学习本课的知识点:
(2)单词:blue,green,red,yellow,black,white,brown,purple,co lor,UFO,CCTV
(3)句型:
—What's this/that?
—It's ...
—What color is it?
—It's ...
2.使学生能运用所学英语,正确地描述物体的颜色。
3.对学生进行美育教育,从小培养他们对美的正确认识。
熟练掌握Ss—Zz八个字母的大小写形式和颜色的表达方法。
这一部分的Guessing game主要是为了让学生从不完整的画面中通过想象,猜出其是什么字母,既复习学过的字母,又丰富学生的想象力。而“What's this?It's ...”既是前一单元的重点句型,也是下一课时使用频率较高的一个句型。我们在游戏的最后用同样的方式引出本堂课所要教授的新字母的小写形式。
For example:
The teacher shows a part of a letter and asks:
Get the students to answer the question like this:
Then show the whole of the letter to let the students check whether they're right or wrong.
导入新课What color is it?
通过字母卡片,复习前面学到的字母及交际用语。
让同学们拿着卡片互相问答。
教师用红色粉笔在黑板上写“A”,询问学生:
The teacher answers himself/herself: It's red.
教师使用不同颜色的粉笔在黑板上写下字母Aa—Rr,让同学们一个接一个地读出来,教师问:
Ss:It's red.(Help the students to answer.)
导入新课 What color is it?
建议3:
T:Good morning,boys and girls.
Good morning,A.
Good morning,B.
(Greet as many students as possible individually.)
T:What color are your clothes?
T:Good.Now please ask and answer questions with your partner about the color of your clothes.
导入新课 What color is it?
Step 2:Present the new letters and words
1.教师通过多媒体呈现一组本课要学习的字母图片,并且每张字母图片颜色不一样,让学生以小组为单位进行辨认。教师可采取竞赛的方式来调动学生的学习积极性。
For example:
T:Look at these pictures.Let's play a game.Who can say these letters and the colors as quickly as possible?If you can,you will be the winner.Now let's begin.
Get some students to ask each other about letters and colors in English,and then do 1a:let the students write the letters for each color.The teacher can offer some help.
2.读一读表示颜色的单词,然后把颜色与对应的单词连起来。
T:They are the names of colors.Draw them on the blackboard or show them on the screen.Now please read after me.You should pay attention to your pronunciation.
Let's match the words with the colors.
建议:
教学过程中我们可以设计一个任务型活动为顺藤摸瓜。在学生学习了有关颜色的词汇后,作为拓展,向学生介绍几个新的表示颜色的词汇,如:dark/light green,orange,pink。这几个词较常见,也很实用。然后通过顺藤摸瓜的游戏加以巩固。具体操作为:
准备10个乒乓球,乒乓球染成10种不同的颜色,然后将10个乒乓球放在一个开口的纸盒子里。上课时,教师找一个学生背对着大家,放音乐,音乐一开始,大家就开始传盒子,音乐一停,手拿盒子的同学马上拿出一个球举起。问控制音乐的同学 “What color is it?” 他猜:“It's red.”。若猜对了,大家说yes,控制音乐的学生继续放音乐;如果大家说“No,it's blue.”,控制音乐的学生下台,由刚才拿球的学生来控制音乐。游戏继续,直到乒乓球在不同学生手里。可以多练几次,让学生充分掌握表示颜色的单词。
该活动参照击鼓传花的游戏而创造。可操作性强,学生积极性也高。能让学生在不知不觉中掌握表示颜色的单词。
1.教师让学生听1b部分的录音,通过听力训练操练所学的新句型。
具体操作建议是:第一遍 让学生只是听,第二遍让学生听并跟读,然后教师让学生进行操练,先学生齐读,然后把学生分成组齐读,最后让个别学生读。通过这种从整体到部分再到个体的机械操练,让学生掌握本课所学的新句型。
2.教师板书并强调What question 句型。
A:What color is it? B:It's red.
A:What color is it? B:It's black.
1.让学生先按照课本的内容练习,建议前后位互问,同位互问,一生随意选择另一学生互问,尽量采取多形式从多角度练习,让更多 的人参与进来。
2.Pa ir work:Let's look at the pictures below.Can you ask and answer questions about the colors?Now work in pairs.Ask your partner about the letters in the pictures.
3.脱离课本,让学生根据身边的事物进行问答,或者用彩笔在白纸上随意写出学过的字母进行问答。
建议1:先复习前面两个单元学过的字母,再过渡到本节课要学习的新字母。
For example:
Please look at the letters.Let's practice saying the letters Aa—Rr in order.
Aa,Bb,Cc,Dd,Ee,Ff,Gg,Hh,Ii,Jj,Kk,Ll,Mm,Nn,Oo,Pp,Qq,Rr
Good.Look at the letters in 2a.They are letters Ss—Zz.Let's listen and repeat them.Pay attention to the pronunciation of the long /i?/sound in T and V and the short /e/ sound in S and Z.The /v/ sounds in V doesn't exist in most Chinese dialects.You should pay special attention.You can't say that like /veI/ or /weI/./zi?/is American English and is also acceptable.
OK.Let's listen and repeat them.
建议2:
1.第一遍让学生只是听,第二遍让学生听并跟读,然后教师让学生进行操练,先学生齐读,然后把学生分成组齐读,最后让个别学生读。通过这种从整 体到部分再到个体的机械操练,让学生掌握本课所学的新字母。
2.教师出示一些带有字母的卡片,并涂上颜色,让学生任意抽取一张,读出字母和表示卡片颜色的单词。为了培养学生的竞争意识,也可以让学生以组为单位进行比赛,每个组选一名代表,看哪个组读得准,读得响亮。
Look at the letters in 2b.They are not arranged alphabetically.Now listen to the tape and number the letters in order,and then read them aloud.
仔细观察2c中字母大小写书写格式,并抄写。教师仔细观察同学们的书写情况,针对存在的`问题及时在黑板上反馈。
建议1:教师在黑板上画出四线格,先演示给同学们看。
建议2:利用投 影仪,以动态的形式展示给同学们看。
根据大写字母写出小写字母,根据小写字母写出大写字母,必须使用四线格。
写完之后找同学读一读,再次巩固字母的读音。对于书写比较漂亮的同学,教师将其书写投影,供大家学习,同时也能激励大家认真书写。
建议:这个游戏叫“非常接触”。在活动前先向学生介绍字母大小写的规则。通过活动——非常接触加以巩固。以每一排为一组,将全班分成若干组,教师分别发给每组最后一排的学生一张纸片,上面写有一个字母,只允许这个学生看这个字母,在教师说“开始”后,最后一排的学生即用手指把纸片上的字母写在前面学生的背上……这样依次进行下去,最后第一排的学生把所传的字母写到黑板的四线格上,传得最快最准确的组获胜。
这一部分并不一定要学生掌握这些缩略词的完整的拼法,主要是为了让学生了解可以运用学过的大写字母来表示一些常见的缩略词或缩写形式。老师也可以补充一些常见的缩略词。
For example:
T:Have you seen these abbreviations?Do you know what they stand for?Now let's look at the pic tures and abbreviations and discuss in groups.
1.小组讨论,展示答案。
2.展示各小组课前收集的缩略词,看看哪组收集得多。
3.教师在屏幕上多展示一些缩略词,让同学们多了解一些。
本课我们主要学习了red,white,yellow,black等表示颜色的单词,S—Z八个字母的读音及大小写形式,还学习了“What color is it?It's red.”两个句型。难点是准确而熟练地描述物体的颜色。在第二课时的学习中我们会继续使用这两个句型进行语言交际。
1.把Ss—Zz八个字母的大小写形式每个写5遍。
2.制作彩色字母卡片,并在卡片上写出本节课学习的句型。
1.What color is it?它是什么颜色的?
【用法透析】该句型结构为“What color +be +名词(代词)+?”用来问某物是什么颜色。
这是对颜色进行提问的特殊疑问句。what是疑问代词,可放在名词前修饰说明名词(color),该句的主语是it,所以动词用单数is,若主语是复数的,则动词用are。该句答语为“It's/They're+颜色.”
2.It's black.它是黑色的。
【用法透析】it是代词,指代前面所提到的东西或人。
【误区警示】注意:its易与it's混淆。it's是it is的缩略式,意思是“它是”,用时要注意以下几点:
①在句首时it's 和it is 两者可以通用。例如:
It's/It is a pen.它是一支钢笔。
That is a car.It's an English car.那是一辆汽车,它是一辆英国生产的汽车。
②作肯定回答时,在Yes之后只能用it is,而不能用it's。如:
—Is this a pen?这是只钢笔吗?
Starter Unit 3 What color is it?
blue,green,red,yellow,black,white,brown,purple,color
What color is it?
It's red...
七年级英语上册课件 篇3
教学重点、难点:
1.重点:描写天气的形容词、感叹句sun+y=sunny,wind+y=windy.
cloud+y=cloudy,snow+y=snowy.etc.
2.难点:感叹句的运用,感叹句的结构和用法What+(a/an)+adj.+n.+S.+V.!
How+adj.+S.+V.!
教学准备:1.CAI课件;2.学生的有关过去几天的天气变化的日记;3.有关当天的天气话题;4.八本英汉汉英字典。
T:Therearefourseasonsinayear.Theyare...
T:Well,Ilikesummerbest.
T:BecauseIlikeswimming.Whataboutyou,S1?
S1:Ilikewinterbest,becauseIlikemakingsnowmen.
T:(AskingtheSs.)WhichseasondoesS1likebest?
1.T:Differentseasons,differentweather.Andeveryday,itchanges.WouldyouliketoknowhowtoexpresstheminEnglish?“Yes!”Ok,nowlet'slearntogether.Atfirstlet'slookatsomebeautifulpictures.
Whenthesunisinthesky,it'ssunny.Wehavealotofsnowthesedays,it'ssnowy.
Whentherearemanycloudsinthesky,it'thereisalotofwind,it'swindy.
ThereisalotofraininEngland,it'srainy.
(用漂亮的彩图展示,给人以视觉感观的刺激;用红色显示sun/sunny,snow/snowy,cloud/cloudy,wind/windy,rain/rainy,突出重点,利用学生已经学习过的句型,在句中学单词,加强语言的运用、表达能力,使词汇的学习灵活、不枯燥乏味)
2.T:LookatPicture5.It'salwaysrainyandwarminEnglandinayear.Liketheweather,thepeopleinEnglandarealwaysgentle,wecallthemgentlemenorgentlewomen.Andtheycarefortheweatherverymuch,theyenjoytalkingaboutit.So,you'dbetterbeginwiththeweatherwhenyoumeetastrangerinEnglandandyoudon'tknowwhattotalkwithhimatthistime.
(学习语言的同时,介绍一些文化背景知识,加深对语言的理解和培养跨文化交际的能力)
3.给学生任务,利用图片在自己所造的句子中学习巩固有关天气的词汇。比如听到:
C:Lookatthetrees.Theyarenotstraight.D:It'swindy.
(“straight”一词,是学生查字典而得出,我及时给予肯定评价,鼓励自主获取知识,拓宽学用渠道)
T:Ifwewanttoknowtheweather,wecansay,Howistheweather?OK!Howistheweather?(领读两遍。)
(前几前,天下雪,今天的天气正好阳光灿烂,但雪正在融化,天气冷。我由学生熟悉的询问身体状况的一句“Howareyou?”引出“Howistheweather?”而询问当天的天气状况,注意了创设情景的真实性)
T:Ifwewanttoknowtheweatherandwecanalsosay,“What'stheweatherlike?”
(幻灯显示:What'stheweatherlike?=Howistheweather?循序渐进、步步深入,由已知引向未知,既复习旧知,又扩展新知,培养思维的连贯性。)
2.Makeuseofthepicturesandyourdiariestomakedialogues.
Youcandolikethis:
Whatisthedatetoday?
It's...
Whatistheweatherlike?
It'sverycold...
(教师走动指导学生同桌对话、前后交叉对话、分组练习,谈论前天、昨天、今天、明天等的日期和天气变化,最后每组两位表演练习)
1.Teacher:It'ssunnytoday.Ifwewanttoexpressourstrongfeeling,It'sverysunny.Wecansay,
幻灯:It'ssunnytoday.→Howsunnyitistoday!
(Workinpairs,thenactout,并尽量用感叹句给予适时评价,如Howwellyouspeak!Howbravetheyare!)
T:Ifwewanttoexpressourstrongfeeling,wecanalsosay,“Whatacolddayitis!”
幻灯:Whatacolddayitis!=Howcolditistoday!
(跟读两遍,看图小组学习,然后每组推荐两位表演,并给予激励性评价)
感叹句的结构和用法What+(a/an)+adj.+n.+S.+V.!
T:Ourclassroomisveryclean.
Ss:Howcleanourclassroomis!/Whatacleanclassroom!
(Letthemworkinpairs,在教室里走动指导时听到:Mycoatisbeautiful!Howbeautifulyourcoatis!Howcolditis!Whatacleverboy!等语言,这时掩饰不住心中的喜悦,说道:HowhappyIam!学生们马上脱口而出:Howhappyyouare!为了巩固,我再次说道:Yes,howhappyIam!WhatahappyteacherIamtoday!然后每组推荐两位表演运用感叹句,并尽量用感叹句给予点评)
Step5Discussandtryyourbesttousewhatwehavelearnedtoday.
(三天前,奥运吉祥物──福娃(Friendlies,现已改名为Fuwa)揭晓,我便显示出下载的彩图和英语WelcometoBeijing.
刚显示就听到:Wa,howbeautiful!这是真情的吐露,马上给予高度评价)
T:Nowlookatthem;youhavetwominutestodiscusseachother.Youcantalkabouttheweather,thepeople,thecities,thefoodinBeijing,andsoon.
(Howsunnyitis!Whatfineweather!Howfriendlyweare!WelcometoBeijing...听到这些表达,我由衷的高兴,因为学生能用感叹句、天气变化的词汇表达自己的感情了)
1.两分钟的讨论后,我把它作为家庭作文,作为学生课外的学习任务;
2.要求收听有关明天天气状况的英语广播、电视或其他渠道的天气信息;
3.今天的英语角主题是运用感叹句谈天气;
4.发给学生一份课堂评价表,记录本节课的知识与情感体验。
七年级英语上册课件 篇4
本单元的核心项目是“喜欢和不喜欢(like and dislike)”。围绕着这一中心项目,课文中设计了各种食物及水果的插图和不同形式的表格,让学生进行听、说、读、写等各种学习活动。通过本单元的教学,使学生学会询问对方与了解别人喜欢与不喜欢的食物,学业会谈论自己与他人早、中、晚餐喜爱吃的食物,为其今后能在交际中恰当地表达自己的情感、灵活运用已经学过的常用功能项目、进一步学习并掌握新的语言功能奠定了坚实的基础。
⑴知识目标:
A、学会询问对方喜欢与不喜欢的`食物;
B、学习并激情些食物的词汇;
C、学会谈论自己与他人早、中、晚餐喜爱吃的食物;
D、学会营养配。
⑵能力目标:
A、能准备表达喜欢和不喜欢的食物;
B、能根据具体情景对话,与他人沟通信息,合作完成任务;
C、通过听、说、读、写四项技能的训练,促进学生语言运用能力的提高。
⑶情感目标:
A、通过学习西文食品文化,促使学生了解西方生活方式与文化,培养跨文化交际的意识;
B、通过开展小组活动,指导学生积极与他人合作,培养他们的合作精神;
C、通过任务型活动,使学生学会在实际生活中均衡饮食,合理配餐。
重点:
A动词like一般现在时的各种句式及一般疑问句的肯定、否定回答;
B关于各种食物的词汇;
教师:搜集关于食物的图片,多媒体教学课件,制作表格(见教学步骤)。
① Present the new words.
T:Let’s play a aguessing game. Is it an apple in my bag?Touch and tell me the answer.
S1: (Touch and say)Yes, it’s an orange.
T:I like oranges. Like means”喜欢”. Read after me .L-I-K-E,like.
T: Do you like oranges?
(Teacher writes the title on the blackboard.)
T: Now today I have a lot of delicious food. First let’t look at some fruit. Look!(Show a picture of a banana.)
T:What’s this in English?It’s a banana. Read after me,B-A-N-A-N-A,banana.
(Then look at some pictures and teach the other fruit words in the same way such as strawberry,apple.)
(Next go on learning the vegetables and the other food in the sme way with the pictures.)
T:Look at the pictures and fill in the chat according to the category.
① Present the countable nouns and the uncountable nouns.
T:Look!What are these? (Show a picture.)
T:How many oranges are there?Let’s count. One,two.
T:And what are these? (Show another picture.)
T:How many apples are there? Let’s count them. One,two,three.
T:Can we count it”Can we say a broccoli?
T:We can’t say a broccoli because it is the uncountable noun. Nouns contain the countable nouns and the uncountable nouns. Countable nouns can be counted with number ,and we add –s or –es to make the blural. For example,we can say an apple, two apples,three eggs. Uncountable nouns can’t be counted with number,and they don’t have plurals. For example, we can say salad, broccoli,but we can’t say salads,broccolis.
T:Look at the pictures. Fill in the chart.(Show some pictures of fruits and vegetables.)
② Present the rules of noun plural forms.
T:look at the pictures,can you say them?
S:Yes,three tomatoes,two oranges, three strawberries.
T:Look at the three rules of plural forms. Are they the same?
① Present the new drills “Do you like…? Yes, I do/ No, I don’t.”
T:Oh,we have lots of delicious fruit. I like apples best.
Do you like them?
S2:No, I don’t. I like salad.
S3:Yes, I do./No, I don’t.
(Ask some more students to practice like this.)
② Practice the drill.
T:Work in pairs.Ask and answer with your pictures.
(Before class the students have drawn some pictures of the food.)
(Then ask more pairs to practice.)
T:Let’s open your books and do 1b.Listen and number1-3.
(The students listen and then check the answers.)
T:Let’s make a survey.You can ask eight friends what they like and dislike. Then fill in the chart.
(Then ask some students to report.)
S1:Five of the students like…, two of them like…
In this class,we’ve learnt the names of foods, fruit and vegetables and practiced asking and answering questions about likes and dislikes. Please remember the rules of noun plurals.
Homework.
Make a survey about your parent’s likes and dislikes using Do you like…?
教师:搜集关于食物的图片,制作表格(见教学步骤)。
② Review the drill “Do you like…”?
③ The girl and the boy are talking about their likes and dislike.Let’s open your books and listen. Try to finish 2a and 2b as quickly as you can.
① Present the new drills “Does she/ he like…? Yes, she / he does./ No, she / he doesn’t”using the chart above.
T:Kate, do you like tomatoes?
T:Do you like ice cream?
(The teacher points at Kate and asks the class.)
T:Does Kate like tomatoes?
T:Does Kate like ice cream?
(The teacher goes on asking Kate using the chart.)
T:Does your best friend Sue like tomatoes?
S1:Yes, she does.(Kate looks at her chart in her hand.)
T:Who is your best friend?
T:Does she like tomatoes?
(The teacher points at Tony and Maria.)
T:Do your best friends like tomatoes?
S1:Yes, they do./No, they don’t.
(The teacher asks two more students to answer his/ her questions according to the chart in their hands. Then the teacher writes down the drills “Does she/he like… ?Do they like…?” on the blackboard.)
T:Work in pairs and practice the drill “Does he/she…? Do they…?”according to the chart.
(Then the teacher asks some pairs of the students to practice one by one.)
② Practice the drills.
T:Let’s work in pairs .
(Student A looks at Page 33.Student B looks at Page 83.Try to find out what Bob and Bill and don’t like.)
Sa:Does Bill like French fries?
Sb: … Does Bob like French fries?
T:Do you love your parents?
T:How do you show your love to them?
S2:I’ll buy something for them when their birthday is coming.
S3:I’ll study better and better.
S4:I’ll make a big meal for them.
T:Oh, I think it’s a good idea. Now let’s try to know what they like and dislike. First take out yesterday’s homework,exchange the information in pairs.
(The teacher have asked the students to have a survey last class.)
T:Does your father like chicken?(Point to a student)
T:Does your mother like eggs?
T:Do they like bananas?
T:Now work in groups and make a food survey.
S2:Jim’s father likes… He doesn’t like… Jim’s mother likes…very much. She doesn’t like…And they both don’t like…
(Then ask more students to report.)
In this class, we’ve learnt the Simple Present Tense,including of the third person singular form as subject.
Homework.
Rewrite your conversation in the form of a passage.
教师:搜集关于食物的图片,多媒体教学课件,制作表格(见教学步骤)。
T:Now let’s cxchange your exercise books and help each other. Try to correct it.(Ask different students to report his/her conversation.)
T:You know we have learnt so much delicious food. Now Let’s play a game with the food. Let’s see who will say the names of the food as many as possible during a minute.
(The teacher will give the students a minute to prepare it.Then ask someone to say.)
S: Salad, apples, bananas, ice cream…
(Choose the three students who said the most and give some food as presents.)
① Present the new words.
T:How many meals do you have every day?
T:What are they?(The students can answer them in Chinese.)
Ss:They are “早餐、中餐和晚餐 ”.
T:Oh, yes. In English “早餐”we can say “breakfast”.
(Show a picture of the breakfast)
Read after me, “breakfast”.
B-R-E-A-K-F-A-S-T,breakfast.
Ss: B-R-E-A-K-F-A-S-T,breakfast.
T:Do you have your breakfast every day?
S1:No, sometimes I get up late, I have no time to eat.
T:I think it’s not good for your health.
(Teach the other two words lunch, dinner in the same way.)
② Practice the words.
T:Which meal do you like best?(Point to a student.)
S:I like breakfast best.
S:Because I like drinking milk.
T:Who also likes breakfast in our class? Please put up your hands.
T:Oh, so many students.You can sit in this team.
(Ask all the students who like breakfast, lunch or dinner to come to the same team. They can talk easily.)
T:We have divided all the class into three groups. One group likes breakfast, the other two like lunch and dinner. But what do you like for your three meals?
(Show a picture of three dinners.)
T:I have three meal plates. What do you want to put on it?
Let’s talk about it. Try to find the food what your group like most and tell us the reason.
(When each group is talking about it, the teacher goes around among the students and helps them if they need. Then ask each group to report.)
S:In our group, we like breakfast best. We all like oranges, eggs, milk and an apple.Because they are good for our health, we choose them.
(When the student is saying, the teacher puts the food onto the plate for breakfast.)
(Do it for lunch and dinner in the same way.)
T:Look at 1a, and write the number in the box next to the correct food.
(Then the students finish off 1a.)
T:How many other food words can you add to the chart?
Try to write them down in the chart.
(The students write them down as soon as possible and then read them. See who will add most.)
Step Four: Practice the listening.
T: Look! There are so many foods. Maybe they are very delicious. Which food do you like? Do you like apples? (Show the picture.)
T: How about chicken? Do you like it ?
T: Can you guess what food I like?
T: Yes, you are right. I think you are very lucky. But I have two friends. They are Sandra and Tom. Do you know what food they like? Now, let’s listen and find out the food you hear.
(Play the recording 2a in Section B. The students find out each food mentioned in the conversation on the recording. Then check the answers.)
T: Now open your books and listen again. Fill in the chart.
(Play the recording the first time. Students listen to the conversation and write in the answers on their charts. Play the recording the second time and then the students can check their answers to be sure they are correct.)
T: Does Sandra like salad?
T: Work in pairs about the chart.
Go on a picnic with a group of friends and make a list of food to buy.
① Divide the students into six groups.
② Talk about what the students in your group like and dislike and make a list.
③ The leader in each group reports to the class.
Step Six: Summary and homework.
Make a survey about “What do your parents like for three meals?” after class.
教师:搜集关于食物和人物图片,制作表格(见教学步骤)。
S: Yes, I do. / Of course.
T: What sport do you like best?
S1:I like playing football/ baskball /table tennis …
T: Oh, Look! What is he doing?
(Show the students a picture of Liu Xiang.)
T: Yes, he is running. Now, read after me, run.
S: Yes, he is Liu Xiang.
T: You are very clever. He is Liu Xiang. He’s a runner.
R-U-N-N-E-R,runner.
T: Now he is very famous in China. Maybe everyone knows him. He is a sport star. S-T-A-R,star.
T: Liu Xiang likes sports. He runs every day. He is healthy and he doesn’t like dessert. Do you know Healthy and dessert? Healthy means “健康的”. Can you guess the meaning of unhealthy?
T: Yes, you are clever. Read after me, healthy, unhealthy.
T: Look at these pictures. (Show these pictures of dessert.)
They are all dessert. In Chinese it means “甜食”.We often eat it after the important dishes.
T: Read after me, dessert, D-E-S-S-E-R-T, dessert.
Ss: D-E-S-S-E-R-T, dessert.
T: Now look at the pictures of these foods. (Show some food pictures.) What kind of food do you think are healthy or unhealthy? Discuss in four people and fill in the chart. (Each group will have a chart)
S: … are healthy food, … are unhealthy food.
T: So we eat more healthy food and less unhealthy food. Healthy food is good for our health, but unhealthy food is bad for our health.
Step Three: Learn to write about what somebody likes for three meals.
① Read the passage.
T: Look at Liu Xiang ! Do you know why he is very healthy?
S1: Maybe he runs every day.
S2: He takes good care of his health.
S3: Maybe he eats very well.
T: Yes, he really eats very well. Every player just eats healthy food. Three is another running star. Her name is Sandra Dlark. Let’s see what she likes eating for three meals. Open your books and read 3a in Section B. First try to fill in the chart.
(The students read the passage and fill in the chart, then check the answers.)
T: Sandra Clark has a brother, Tom. He is very clever, but a little naughty. Look at 3b and find out what Tom likes for breakfast, lunch and dinner. Complete the following passage.
(The students do 3b and check the answers.)
② Practice.
T: I like eggs and milk for breakfast. What do you like eating for breakfast?(Point to a student.)
S: I like apples and bread.
T: What about you? (Point to another student.)
S: I like hamburgers and bananas.( Ask two more students to answer his/her questions for lunch and dinner.)
T: Who can ask and answer like this?
Sa: What do you like to eat for lunch?
Sa: What do you like to eat for dinner?
(Then ask the students to work in pairs one by one.)
① Write a passage about you like for three meals.
T: Can you introduce yourself for three meals according to what you talked about just now? Maybe many friends want to know you. (The students write about themselves as quickly as they can. When they are ready, ask them to introduce.)
② Make a survey about your classmates for three meals.
T: Do you have any friends? (Ask a student.)
S: Yes, I do./ Of course.
T: Do you know what they like eating for each meal?
S: No/ Sorry, I don’t know.
T: OK. Let’s ask our friends and try to know what they like. Then fill in the chart.
(Then ask some students to report to the class.)
Homework.
Write a passage about your best friend for three meals.
七年级英语上册课件 篇5
本节是单元第一课时,通过观察多张照片,对其中人物所做事情的讨论,锻炼学生的观察能力及表达能力,通过进一步的游戏环节,拓展新的学习内容,体现了英语教育的趣味性和实用性。
1.掌握现在进行时的运用和表达的意思,关注人称和动词的搭配。
2.句型What are you doing?I’m doing sth..
What is he/she doing?He/she is doing sth..
Is he/she doing sth.?Yes,he/she is.或No,he/she isn’t.
3.掌握肯定句和一般疑问句的句型转换及其回答。
1.培养学生学以致用的能力,养成良好的`观察能力。
2.培养学生主动参与学习,善于与他人合作学习的能力。
培养学生热爱学习,热爱劳动,热爱生活,珍惜生命的积极的人生观。
教学重点:What are you doing?I’m doing sth..
What is he/she doing?He/she is doing sth..
Is he/she doing sth.?Yes,he/she is.或No,he/she isn’t.
教学难点:用be doing来表示说话的瞬间正在做某事。
采用让学生动手操作、合作探究、媒体演示的教学方法来突出重点、突破难点。
本节课主要是对于正在发生的事情进行讨论,先利用欣赏电影片段吸引学生的注意力,教育学生要热爱生活,再利用观看照片来讨论某一瞬间发生的事情。并在课堂教学中将尽量为学生提供参与活动的场景,用任务型教学法让学生进行小组学习,抓住英语交际的机会,感知体验,大胆实践,使学生自得知识、自寻方法、自觅规律、自悟道理。
1.Greeting :
Teacher: Hello, everyone. How are you? Today is a nice day, isn’t it?So what do you want to do? And why?点一个举手的学生回答,再面向全班: I like watching TV at home. Because it’s relaxing. Do you want to watch TV?得到肯定回答后,T:Now let’s go to watch TV.进入幻3,点击右下角的铃铛播放电影《泰坦尼克》结尾片段。看完后,T:Do you know its name? Do you like it? Why?学生回答后,老师显示字幕:Don’t let go. Love your life.
设计目的:通过观看著名的电影片段来吸引学生的注意力,向学生灌输热爱生活珍惜生命的情感教育。
1、T:I have some photos.展示幻4的照片:Look! This is my life.I’mdoing some things at home.用红外线灯照射每张照片,学生可以通过照片明白句子的意思。老师指着每张照片带读句子(同时做出相应的动作):I’m watching TV/cleaning/reading/talking on the phone/playing computer games/teaching.认读完最后一张自己上课的照片后,T: what’s my job? ... yes,I’m a teacher.
然后老师设计打电话的场景:hello, thisisMiss Liu. Today is a nice day. I’m watching TV at home. What about you?进行师生间的对话,起示范作用,让学生能仿造使用幻灯片上的句子回答,并对能使用其他动作回答的同学予以奖励。每个be doing形式都用红色标注,提示学生注意。
设计目的:通过展示老师自己的照片吸引学生的注意,输出新知识,用带读和创设情境的对话形式,让学生初步理解并能表达自己正在做某事。
展示幻5,T:now,let’s look at other photos. Who is in these photos?老师问几个举手的学生:what are you doing?然后让学生仿照进行pairwork活动:Can you ask your friend ‘what are you doing’?并请几组进行演示,每组演示之后,老师问大家:what is…doing?借机转换人称。
设计目的:创情设景,用学生自己的schoollife照片让大家有话可说,并可借机转换人称,转入下一环节。
展示幻6,T:now,we are in a happy apartment. These people are doing some things. Let’s listen to the conversation. Then tell me: What are these people doing?听完录音后,T ask S1:what is Jenny doing? S1: she is watching TV.T点击屏幕检验。T转向S2:Can you ask your friend about Dave and Mary?然后用以上问句依次请几组同学对图中人物内容进行问答。
设计目的:充分挖掘听力材料,利用其锻炼学生们的听说能力,并成功实现转换人称的问答,使学生能了解并掌握如何询问其他人正在做什么及其回答。
展示幻7,T:now,let’s make a survey in your group. What are your friends doing now? I’ll give you 3 minutes. You can ask 4 friends, and write down on the chart, then make a report.3分钟之后,T: Can you make a report?请每组派一代表汇报,并进行奖励,T可以插入问句:what is … doing ?。
设计目的:通过小组活动培养学生的合作学习能力和认真聆听他人的良好习惯。
1、展示幻8,T:Look! Tom is doing something. Do you know, what is Tom doing?Oh, let me guess. Is Tom writing? S: No, he isn’t. T继续猜,直到S说Yes, he is.为止。点击可检验答案。再点击出现下一个人物。重复以上老师猜,学生答的活动。
设计目的:因为此片内容是书上有的,学生知道谜底,所以由老师做示范来猜,学生回答,锻炼学生认真听的习惯。
2、展示幻9,T:Now, It’our fun time. Do you know this cat? What’s his name? S: ... T: yes, he’s Tom.Now,Let’s talk about these pictures. You can ask your friends in your group,what is Tom doing?3 students as a group. And One ask, the others answer .每组发一份图片进行组内讨论。份图片进行组内讨论。3分钟后请几组学生演示,T:You can ask 2 questions.3人一组,一人用红灯照射图片问,另两人答,奖励表现良好的小组。
设计目的:在重温对话what is he doing?的同时,了解各图的内容,为下一环节做铺垫。
3、点击出现幻10和问句Is Tom sleeping?T: Now, What is Tom doing? Is Tom sleeping? (T做睡觉的动作)全班看着图片齐答:Yes, he is.或No, he isn’t.
T:Who wants to guess the next picture?请一个学生上台来背对屏幕玩猜谜游戏:示意全班问他:What is Tom doing?此学生边做动作边猜测:Is Tom drinking?全班齐答Yes,he is.或No,he isn’t.猜到者有奖。
设计目的:在游戏中学,在快乐中锻炼听说能力,避免了枯燥的教与学。
请一个学生对于此课所学进行总结,老师给予及时的评论,并点击进入幻11展示语法小结:现在进行时态。
设计目的:初一的内容是基础教学,语法在最后有必要呈现出来,让大家知道所学内容的专业术语。让学生自己总结更能加深印象。
七年级英语上册课件 篇6
教学目标 1. Get the students learn the new words: guitar, sing, swim, dance, chess, play chess, draw, speak, speak English, join, club
2. Get the students learn the sentence patterns: ① —Can you play the guitar? —Yes, I can./ No, I can't. ② —What can you do? —I can dance. ③ —What club do you want to join? —I want to join the chess club.
3. Learn the grammar focus: modal verb “can” and “want to do sth”
4.Raises student's group consciousness
难点 1. Learn to talk about the abilities.
2. The usage of modal verb “can”
方法 Task-based, grading method、audio-visual instruction、demonstration、Situational Teaching Method.
1. Ss look at the picture in 1a. Then read the words and phrases. Let Ss match the activities with the people.
2. Then Check the answers with the class together.
Show the pictures about the abilities and say:
He/She can dance/swim/sing/"??But I can’t dance/swim/sing/...
T: Tell your partners what you can do. For example:
I can play the guitar. I can sing and dance.
Ss work in groups. The let some Ss talk to their classmates in front of the class.
1. T: Now let’s listen to the tape, find out the right conversation, and number them 1-3.
1. Ask the Ss to practice the conversations in 1b with a partner. Then make their own conversations. Ⅵ. Listening
1. Work on 2a;
T: Now, look at the pictures on P2, listen to the four conversations. Just listen.
(Play the recording for the first time, students only listen carefully.)
Then, listen to the recording again, and circle the clubs you hear.
Check the answers with the class.
2. Work on 2b;
3. Check the answers with the Ss.
1. Look at 2b and talk about what the people can do and the clubs they want to join.
T: What club does Lisa want to join?
S1: She wants to join the chess club.
2. Ss work in pairs to practice asking and answer about Lisa, Bob and Mary.
3. Ask some pairs to act out their conversations.
Ⅷ.Homework:
1. Remember the new words and expressions after class.
2. Recite the conversation after class.
3. Write English names as many as possible in the exercises book.
Ⅸ.Blackboard design Section A 1 (1a-2d)
Drills:
1. —Can you sing? —Yes, I can./No, I can't.
2. 2b: 1. chess, chess 2. English; English 3. sing, dance, music
4. ① What club does Bob join?
② What club does Jane join?
They want to have some rice and vegetables.
七年级英语上册课件 篇7
课题: Comic strips Welcome to the unit(第一课时)
学习目标:
1.引入有关地点和交通的话题。
2.谈论参观访问和交通方式。 3.辨别方位。
认识路__________________ 爬上山 ____________
跟随我__________________ 在北京的西南_______________
下来 __________________ 乘地铁去市中心____________________
不要害怕 ________________ 不得不 ________________
一次春游________________ 进行一次远足________________
一、根据地理位置,用适当的方位词填空。
1. Guangzhou is in the ____________ of China.
2.Beijing is in the ______________ of China.
3.Shanghai is in the ______________of China
4. Kunming is in the _______________ of China.
5. Harbin is in the ________________ of China.
jiang is in the _________________ of China.
二、根据汉语提示及所给词的适当形式完成下列句子。
1. We are _________(害怕) of tigers.
2. My daughter likes ___________ (跟随) me to go shopping.
七年级英语上册课件 篇8
课题Starter Module2 Unit1课型listeningandspeaking
教学重点What’s this/that? It’s a/an… book,bag,chair,desk…
教学课程1.Greeting.
T: What’s this in English?
T: How do you spell it?
Work in pairs. Ask and say.
S1: What’s this in English/
S1: What’s that in English?
S1: How do you spell it?
1) Listen and repeat.
2) Compelete the sentences and read.
3) Write the sentences.
课后评价。
七年级英语上册课件 篇9
Unit3 This is my sister.
Key vocabulary: son , cousin , daughter , uncle , picture .
Target language: This is his friend. That is his sister. These are his parents. Those are his grandparents.
Train Ss’ listening skill. Train Ss’ intuition thought ability.
Ss should help with household and respect parents.
Key vocabulary. Target language.
Ss can introduce their family members everyday situations.
A tape recorder.
A picture of my family and friends.
T: Let’s play a guessing game. Please listen carefully. He is my brother. But my father is not his father. His father is not my father. His father and my father are brothers. We have the same grandfather. Who is he?
S2: It is your “堂兄” or “堂弟”.
T: Yes, it is. Let’s see how to say it in English.
T: It’s cousin. Read after me, C-O-U-S-I-N, cousin.
SS: C-O-U-S-I-N, cousin.
SS: C-O-U-S-I-N, cousin.
…
T: This time you must say it in English. She is your sister. But your father is not her father. Her father is not your father. Her father and your father are brothers. You have the same grandmother. Who is she?
T: Your father’s brother is your …?
T: You are right. Let’s see how to say it in English.
T: Read after me, please, U-N-C-L-E, uncle.
…
T: Your uncle’s wife is your…?
(Teach the new words son and daughter in the same way.)
T: Read the words together.
Task Three Practice the new words
T: Look at the family tree. Some words are missing. Add the words in the box, please.
Task One Listen and check the words you hear.
T: Lin Hai and Dave are talking about Dave’s family. How many family members are they talking about? Please listen and check the words you hear.
(Play the recording of 2a once.)
(Ask two more students to say the answers.)
Task Two Listen and check the picture.
T: I have two pictures here. Which one is Lin Hai talking about? Let’s listen and find it out, please.
(Play the recording twice again.)
Task One Pairwork. Draw your own picture and talk about it.
T:We find out the picture of Lin Hai’s family. Can you draw a picture of your family?
T: OK. When you finish drawing, tell your partner about your picture. You can use “This is …” and “ These are …” to talk about. Then report it to the class.
(Check students’ work. Ask two or three students to report.)
Task Two Talk about the family tree.
T: Look at the family tree. I think it’s a big family. You can do it
in groups of four or three. You can do it in pairs or only by yourself. Then report it to the class.
(Students work. Teacher walks around in the classroom and helps the students.)
T: Stop here. Let’s check it out.
S1: Look at my family tree. This is my… This is my … They have two … This is my … This is my …This is my …This is my. My parents have two children. This is…This is my …My uncle and my aunt have a son. He is my …
(Ask two more students to do it.)
Task Three Homework.
Write a passage about your family.
七年级英语上册课件 篇10
1. 方位介词:in、on、under、behind、in front of、near等的.用法。
2. Where引导的特殊疑问句和一般疑问句Is the ... in/on/under the ...的回答。
3. 新单词:bed、table、bookcase、chair。
采用目标和任务教学法,调动学生的积极性,引导他们积极参与课堂。
Where引导的特殊疑问句和一般疑问句Is the ... in/on/under the ...的交际。
明确任务,以学生为主体。加强小组合作学习,积极回答问题。 教学准备
Greet the students as usual.
Play an English song before class to interest the students. Revise some school things by asking questions. e.g.:
What’s this?
Is this a ...
How do you spell it? etc.
Learn the new words in, on, under, behind ... by helping the teacher find the lost things. T: Where’s my English book?
S1: It’s here./I think it’s ... T: Oh, it’s on the desk. …
T: Where’re my color pencils? S2: ...
Teach the new word “where” and the use of “they”.
Consolidate the prepositions by looking at the screen and answer the questions: Where’s ... ? Where’re ...
Students hide and look for the school things in pairs. One student hide one school thing and asks: Where’s…? Where’re…? The other student guess and answer: It’s in your desk. They are in your pencil case. etc. Ask some pairs to share their performances.
Show the students a picture of a room, tell them this is a bedroom and let the students list the things in it first. Then show them the whole picture, teach the new words, ask where the things are, and let the students answer, using the prepositions.
Repeat with a sitting room and a study, teach the new words and practice in the same way.
Work on 1a Match the words with the things in the picture. Students do it individually first, then check the answers.
Work on 1b play the tape for the students and ask them to number the things in the picture. Then ask one students to report the answers.
Work on 1c Make up dialogues in pairs, using the things in the picture. Let two pairs show their dialogues
Show a picture of a room, give the students one minute to look at it, then ask them what kind of things they saw and where the things are. Have a competition among groups. See which group can remember all the things and places.
Copy the new words and try to remember them. Make a survey:
Interview one of your friends.Fill in the form below. Name Ms. Zhang/ Liu Hai Things sofa Places near the wall
( ) 1. Where _________ the CDs?
( ) 2. ——_________ my alarm clock? ——_________ on the bed.
A. Where, It B. Where’s, It’s C. Where are, They’re D. Where, It’s
( ) 3. _________ her hat on the sofa?
本节课单词较多,因此最好采用实物或图片教学法来教这些新单词,这样更具有直观效果,所设计课堂环节一定要能激发学生的兴趣,本堂课所设计的游戏环节就非常好。
七年级上册英语课件(精选十四篇)
宜未雨绸而缪,毋临竭而掘井。当幼儿园教师的工作遇到难题时,我们经常会用提前准备好的资料进行参考。资料的定义范围较大,可指代生产资料。资料对我们的学习工作发展有着重要的意义!那么,你知道有哪些常见幼师资料吗?你不妨看看七年级上册英语课件(精选十四篇),欢迎大家借鉴与参考,希望对大家有所帮助。
七年级上册英语课件【篇1】
青铜峡第五中学 王俊霞
教材分析
1、教学内容
1)、词汇:have,soccer,ball,tennis racket,ping-pong ball,volleyball,basketball sport,bat,2)、语言结构:A、Do you have a ping-pong ball?Yes,I do。Do you have a ping-pong bat?Not,I do not。Does she/he have a pen?Yes,she/he does
2、教材的地位及其作用
本单元的教学主要内容是:学习have的一般现在时的疑问式的肯定和否定回答,该话题与学生的日常生活紧密联系在一起,容易唤起学生的学习兴趣,这对于提高学生的综合能力很有帮助,特别是说的能力。
本单元仍在继续学习一般现在时,这是一个生活中离不开的时态,也是最基本的一个时态。新课程标准要求学生重点掌握一般现在时,这在英语中使用频率很高,学好这一时态的用法对以后其他时态的学习和交际有很大的帮助。
二、学生分析
学生现有的能力与已掌握的知识:
学生在已经学过词汇:What is this ? What is that? 句型: Where is„? It’s in / on / under/„
经过前面的学习学生已经积累了一定的词汇,掌握了一定的目标语,已经具备了一定的听说读写能力。
三、教学目标
1、语言知识
词汇:A、重点掌握表示有关各种运动球类的名词, 如basketball, soccerball,so on 重点句型:? Do you/they have a TV? Yes,I/they do./No,I/they don’t.Does he/she have a soccer ball? Yes,he/she does./No,he/she doesn’t.2、语言技能
1)、能看着图片说;Do you/they have a TV? Yes,I/they do./No,I/they don’t.Does he/she have a soccer ball? Yes,he/she does./No,he/she doesn’t.3、学习策略
1)、利用老师所提供的图片卡片做出简单的判断。
2)、通过与同学交流,学会使用一般现在时的疑问形式及肯定和否定回答。
4、情感态度
1)通过各小组的对话练习培养学生的合作精神; 2)通过学习本单元,教会学生之间互相有无的主要句式
重点难点
1、Have 的一般现在时的疑问式用法;
2、Have的一般现在时的疑问句,及其肯定,否定回答;
3、简单拓展主语第三人称单数的句型。
教学手段:采用最简单的卡片图片、课本以及肢体语言。理念与思路、教法
1)采用图片进行直观教学。
2)学生在课堂教学过程中口头训练应成为本单元教学的重点内容。教学突破:Section A重在通过使用动词have对物品的所属进行提问和回答的交流式口语活动,学习由助动词do或does引导的一般疑问句的构成以及回答。教师要善于引导学生比较行为动词的疑问句和be动词的疑问句在构成和回答上的区别,通过大量和反复地操练以达到运用自如。
四、教学流程
一、第一教学环节:情景创设,导入新课 教师活动 学生活动
Section A主要内容是通过使用have对物品的所属进行提问和应答,来学会使用do和does引导的一般疑问句。所以在教学中可采取问答式导人法:
掌握新单词.采用各种方法学习单词。
1、升降语调、拼读、接龙和肢体的方式记忆单词。2.检查学生记忆单词的成效。
3、学生看1a的图片,使字母和单词相对应。
第二教学环节;老师和学生互动:学习掌握重要内容。
教师活动 学生活动(看图片练句型)
分片进行演示:I have a footba11.Do I have a football? 自己回答:Yes,I d0. 再问:Do I have a basketball? 自己回答:No,I don’t.再使用其它物体和图片询问学生:Do I have„? 询问学生:Do you have„? 询问学生:„? 询问学生:Do they have„? 在学生充分掌握的第一,第二人称和第三人称 的复数。
2.学生回答:Yes,you do.,you don’t.学生回答:Yes,I do.No,I don’t.学生回答:Yes,he/she does.No,he/she doesn’t.学生回答:Yes, they do.No,they don’t.掌握它的肯定和否定回答。
3、要求学生完成1b的听力,达到教学应完成的任务。
4.引导学生展开Pairwork活动,完成lc部分口语交际的教学任务,学会运用助动词do进行问答,可采用师生互动带动学生互动的交流方式:
5.Pairwork活动,完成lc部分口语交际的学习任务,学会运用助动词do进行问答并上台展示口语交际。
三、第三教学环节:合作交流,巩固提高
教师活动 学生活动
1、学生巩固练习活动,完成课堂练习和总结及笔头练习的教学任务。
2、让总结本课的 主要内容,如果不周到,教师可以补充完成。
3、游戏:让一个学生在课前 作各种动作,其他学生跟根据他的动作写单词和句型,然后核对结果。这种活动既可练习have一般疑问句的构成和回答的写法,又能调动学生的学习兴趣,十分有效。
4、习题练习,巩固课堂。问题探究与拓展活动
动词的第三人称单数形式:当句子的主语是“第三人称单数”时,即:不是I,不是you的其它单数形式时,谓语动词必须改变形式,也就是在词尾加一s或 一es(同名词的复数形式),我们可以简称为“三单形式”。有些动词的变化是特殊的,如:have的三单形式是has。在构成否定句时。要在动词前加助动词don’t或doesn’t;在构成疑问句时,则要在主语前加上助动词do或does,does/doesn’t是do/don’t的第三人称单数形式。助动词后应该用动词的原型。
五、教学反思:(成功和不足)
本单元重点学习的语法是do 和 does 引导的一般疑问句以及它们的回答方式,与此同时学习与运动有关的一些词汇。为此,在本单元我运用不同形式鼓励学生使用目标语言,在任务中体现学生的主体地位。在过程中学生可能出现一些错误,本人就以积极的态度对待他们,愉快的氛围对学生的学习有很大的积极影响力。首先要调动学生的学习兴趣和积极性,我努力在这方面去做,不足的请各位多提宝贵意见。
教无定法,教师不要为了任务活动而忽略了语言的传授。学生的信息交流要在特定的环境中进行,给他们参与的机会。任务的完成不是语言学习的结束,而是另一个高度的开端。加强学生语言的实践是改革的关键,要给学生机会去说、去做、去思考。
新目标英语上册/Unit 1 My name's Gina 教学目标
1、学会询问周围新同学的姓名,并且将自己刚认识的好朋友介绍给全体同学。
2、通过学生制作名卡或桌卡来提高学生学习英语的兴趣,体现英语的实用性。
3、通过以上任务活动,掌握形容词性物主代词的用法及其与人称代词的主格的区别,并且在第一节课让学生对英语的学习产生兴趣。
4、德育目标:热爱班集体,团结同学。
教学重点和难点
1、形容词性物主代词的用法
2、在任务活动中掌握you和your,he和his, she和her 的用法
3、重点句型(斜体字为扩展句子):
Hi / Hello!Good morning / afternoon / evening.How are you? Fine, thank you!/ Very well / So-so /All right.What’s your name? My name is … / I’m … What’s his/ her name? His/Her name is … 课前准备
1、学生课前准备:
利用网络查阅中英文姓名及初次见面时各国或各地风俗,礼仪体会它们的不同之处;
准备硬纸片和水彩笔;
用英文介绍自己的姓、名。
2、教学器材:录音机、电脑、图片。
3、教学课件:中英文名字展示片。
教学设计
Tasks Students’ activities Teacher’s activities
1.Game: ask and answer the question: What’s your name? Students make a self-introduction and pass the sentences one by one.At first, teacher makes a self-introduction.2.Two students act out how to greet people.Act out the greeting forms they are familiar with or they find on the students the pictures of other countries’ customs with computer.3.See who can make the most friends and get the most information.Then report their results with his or hers.Move around to make friends with the ones they are interested in.Make the students move around to make friends with others. and make their name and make their name cards in groups.Ask them to design their name cards and see which group is the best.教学过程设计
任务一:结识新朋友。
1、老师首先向学生做一个自我介绍,将名字写在黑板上: My name is …, My first name is…, My last name is …同时介绍一下名字的意义,然后学生就近组成若干小组,进行自我介绍。例如:一个学生叫徐烨,他说:My name is Xu Ye.Ye means light;一个叫王超的学生介绍说: My name is Wang Chao.Chao means Superman。这个任务能够激起学生学习英语的兴趣,同时扩大词汇量。
2、“What’s your name?”传句子比赛。学生按行分组,一个同学问,“What’s your name?”第二个学生回答,“My name is …”然后再接着问第三个人, “What’s your name?” 第三个人答,“My name is … His/ her name is …”再接着问第四个人What’s your name?”。。看哪个组最先获胜。
任务二:学生利用电脑向大家展示他们所搜集的中英文姓,问候语名及各国或各地初次见面时的礼仪,体会它们的不同之处;然后由抽签决定各组同学分别用哪个国家或哪个地区的礼仪(例如:日式、美式、法式和学校版的礼仪)来表演两个人初次见面时的问候语及谈话内容(用英文),看哪一组同学表演的形象,语言准确,最后评出最佳组合。
任务三:找朋友。并将他或她加入你的朋友记录中。该任务是通过学生自己去询问他们感兴趣的同学的爱好,找出他们之间的共同点,然后和他们交朋友(利用时间争取和所有的同学交朋友,了解他们各自的优点),并将自己所掌握的新朋友的信息介绍给全体同学,让大家了解他(们)。在该任务的执行过程当中,学生可以尽量施展他们的才能,倾尽其所学的英文知识来展示自己并且看谁能获得最多的信息。因此,这项任务在调动学生学习英语兴趣的同时,也反复操练了本单元的关键句型和形容词性物主代词,尤其是he and his, she and her;同时运用到一些超出本课教学内容的语言知识,学生参与性强,最大限度的调动了他们的积极性,同时也为学生树立了英语学习的信心。
Name Hobbies Other information
任务四:制作姓名卡。制作姓名卡,由小组协作共同完成姓名卡的设计与制作,姓名卡中要求包括学生的汉语名字(拼音书写)和英文名字,其他的内容由各组自行设计,但要求每个人的姓名卡的设计要有创意、体现小组的共性、美观大方、经久耐用、语言准确。因此,该任务既体现个性,又体现共性;既有分工,又有合作。
任务五:作业。为自己、父母、亲朋好友找一个有意义的英文名字,同时将他们介绍给你的同学们。
教学点评(或反思)
本节课的设计体现了任务型教学的特点,同时整个任务链的设计均以学生的兴趣
为主,由易至难,逐层递进,逐步完成各个任务,使学生在愉快的完成每一个任务的同时,体会到学习英语的乐趣,并使每一位学生都参与到活动中,都有所提高。本节课由于是新学期的第一节课,在教学中,本着 “新学期、新起点、新观念、新
认识”的观点设计了四个快乐的任务,同时这几个任务相互连接,环环相扣,形成了一个完整的任务链。整节课课堂气氛活跃,学生学习英语的兴趣始终很浓。尤其是“找朋友”这个任务,极大地调动了学生的积极性,学生们说出了很多精彩的句子。而在制作姓名卡时,各小组通力合作,氛围和谐,作品各具特色,体现了任务型教学中共同合作与个性张扬的优势。在解释自己名字的任务中,充分调动了学生的表现欲,学生们的名言经整理后被保留下来,提高了学生学习英语的积极性。
在各国礼仪表演中学生既学到了英文知识,又了解了其他各国各地的风俗,将知识“延伸到课堂之外的学习和生活之中”。因此,这节课中的活动具有可操作性,并以学生的生活经验和兴趣出发,使学生的思维和想象力、审美情趣得到发展,从而提高学生实际语言运用能力。
另外,本节课的德育目标,使英语教学与其他学科结合起来。
当然本节课中也存在几个需要继续探索的问题:
一、师生均是初次接触任务型教学,对其仅是好奇及尝试,尚未能领会其主旨。
二、活动中课堂秩序稍有些乱,在以后课堂中应加以指导。
教师本身也需要提高对新课标和任务型教学的认识,以完善今后的教学。
英文版英语说课稿
Good morning, everyone!Today, I’ll say something about Unit 5 Section A in Book1 of GO FOR IT English.Background on the reformation of curriculum, this book can connect the life and act, emphasize the interest and experience of the Ss, the pictures are active and vivid.Grade four is the initial stage of English learning, so it stresses on the emotion of the Ss, creates a well beginning for the Ss.This Unit has 7 parts, we’ll learn sectionA mainly, it embodies the repeating characterize.Review the learned language points “Where’s„”and the new language points will be represented in the following units.So this unit forms connecting links with a special meaning in this book.The content of this period is to use “Where’sare„” to determine the place.And according to the contents and the fact of the Ss, I establish the following three teaching aims of this period: Aims on the knowledge: students can listen, read, say and spell the following words: a glass, a fridge, an egg, bread and a table.Aims on the abilities: students can listen, read, say and write the following daily expressions: What’s for breakfast?
Have some juice then.Aims on the emotion(1)To foster Ss’ consciousness of good co-operation and proper competition.(2)To lead Ss to show their loveliness to the poor.III.Key-points of this lesson(1)To help Ss ask and answer the question: What’s in it?
(2)To enable Ss to study in groups and co-operate skillfully.(3)To develop Ss’ interest in English.IV.Difficult points(1)To help the Ss ask and answer the question “What’s in it?” and make sure they can use the plural nouns correctly.(2)To finish the survey by themselves.V.Teaching methods As we all know: the main instructional aims of learning English in primary school is to cultivate pupils’ basic abilities of listening and speaking and their good sense of the English language.So in this lesson I’ll mainly use “Task-based” teaching method.That is to say, I will let the Ss learn in real situations, finish a task by making a survey to help the Ss to get a better understanding of the key structure of the dialogue.I will arrange four kinds of activities: singing, guessing game, finishing a survey and having a competition.And in this lesson a recorder, PPT, school things and a printed form will be needed.Students should prepare some school things.VI.Teaching procedures and purposes of my designing.I’ll finish this lesson in five steps.Step 1.Warm-up and preview 1.Free talk between T and Ss about things in the classroom.2.Sing the song together: Books and pencils.3.Do some TPR, for example: Show me your English me your crayon.4.Review the numbers by asking: “How many crayons do you have?”
Purpose: It is important to form a better English learning surrounding for the Ss by singing and doing some total physical response and at the same time.it provides situations to review learned knowledge for the next step.Step 2.Presentation Now I’ll mainly talk about this step.1.Present the pattern: “My schoolbag is heavy.” “What’s in it?.”(1)Show a bag and say: “Look!I have a bag.” Carry it and say: “Oh, it is heavy.My schoolbag is heavy.” Help the Ss understand the meaning with the help of my body language.Then lead the Ss to read the sentence.Make sure they can say it correctly.(2)T: My schoolbag is heavy.Open the bag and say: “What’s in it? What’s in my schoolbag?” Take out a Chinese book.Then do the action again.Let the Ss read the sentence.2.Play a guessing game.Divide the whole class into four groups to have a competition.Let them guess: What’s in the bag? How many?
Purpose: To present the key structures one by one is much easier for the Ss to learn and grasp the per competition can arouse the Ss’ interest in English learning.3.With the help of the PPT to present the dialogue.Set a situation to help Ss understand: Two Ss are coming.One girl is carrying a heavy bag on her back.They are talking.Girl: My schoolbag is heavy.Boy: What’s in it?
Girl: 20 story-books, 32 pencil, 9 rulers, 12 crayons and 30 picture-books.Etc.Boy: What will you do? Girl: They are for the poor.Boy: Great!I’ll bring some school things too.The boy comes back home and puts a lot of things into the bag.Then he goes to school again and gives them to a teacher.While he is taking them out, he is counting the numbers of all things.The teacher says: Thank you soooooooo much.4.Mention that we should take care of the poor.5.Play the tape.Let the Ss listen and imitate the dialogue.Pay attention to their pronunciation and intonation.Purpose: PPT can provide a real situation for the Ss to understand the dialogue and the relationships between people better.Tell the Ss we should show our loveliness to the Ss.Step 3.Practice Divide Ss into groups of six children.Each one would finish the printed form by asking and answering: How many storybooks do you have? Find out which group finishes faster.Purpose: Task-based teaching method is used here to develop Ss’ ability of communication and also their ability of co-operation will be well trained.Step 4.Assessment Help Ss finish “Let’s check” of this unit and workbook.Purpose: To check the knowledge Ss have learned in this period.Step 5.Add-activity 1.Let Ss tell each other how many school things they have after class.Tell their parents how many school things they have at home.2.Take care of everything they have.Purpose: Revision is so important that Ss should speak English as much as they as in class or after class.It is necessary for the Ss to do some extensive exercise after class to consolidate the knowledge they learned.In a word, the whole period is based on tasks, which are designed from easy steps to steps that are challenging.When the Ss are carting out the tasks, they can acquire information, knowledge, and have their ability and skills trained.That’s all.Thanks a lot for your attention.
七年级上册英语课件【篇2】
一、教材分析
本单元是人教版《新目标》的第六单元。这本教材的词汇量很大,内容新颖,尤其是生动活泼的卡通化的画面,很符合七年级学生的年龄特点和心理特点,其中还囊括了很丰富多彩的文化知识,以及合作探究的活动,十分贴近学生的实际生活经验。
本单元的主要话题food与日常生活密切相关,贴近学生生活,能引起学生的特别关注,易激发学生学习英语的欲望和兴趣,是学生乐于参与各种英语实践活动,这是英语新课程标准中规定所必须掌握的内容,是交际英语中必不可少的项目。因此,本单元对于提升学生的学习兴趣而提高学生的听、说、读、写能力有很大的帮助。并通过self check检测,积极地、及时地寻找各自的不足,以便学生树立良好的内在动机,不断获得成就感。
二、教学目标
1、教学目标
⑴知识目标
Section A主要话题是食物及偏好,其中主要涉及内容如下:
A、Functions功能:谈论喜欢和不喜欢的食物、
B、Structures语法结构:动词like的肯定句,否定句,疑问句及其回答;主语是单数第三人称时like的用法,助动词do的用法、
C、Target Language日常交际用语:
Do you like salad?Yes,I do、 No,I don’t、
I like bananas、
I don’t like apples、
Does he/she like salad?Yes,he/ she does、 No,he/ she doesn’t、
He/ She likes apples、
He/ She doesn’t like apples、
D、Vocabulary词汇:like,banana,hamburger,tomato,broccoli,French fries,orange,ice cream,salad,strawberry等。
(2)能力目标
培养学生运用所学句型谈论喜好和饮食习惯。
(3)情感目标
通过询问他人喜好的食物和事物,学会关心他人,增进彼此感情、
通过学习,使学生养成健康饮食习惯、
2、教学重点、难点
(1)重点:学习并运用谈论喜好及食物的交际用语及词汇。
(2)难点:动词like肯定句,否定句,疑问句及回答的用法。以及单三人称的使用
3、教具准备:多媒体支持,大量相关图片,动画以及资料
4、课时安排:本课是unit 6的第一节课,包括Section A全部P31—P33、
三、 教学设计理念
本课时教学设计强调从学生的学习兴趣,生活经验和认知水平出发,结合学生实际,谈论学校喜欢和不喜欢的食物。提倡采用任务型语言教学途径和方法,鼓励学生在教师的指导下,通过体验、实践、参与、探索和合作等方式,发现语言的规律,逐步掌握语言知识和技能,不断调整情感态度,形成有效的学习策略和自主学习能力。
四、教学方法
1、听说法:以听、说、读、写、练为主,通过对本课重点句型的学习培养学生听力、口语以及书面语的能力。
2、交际法:注意语言的运用能力,培养学以致用的意识,有利于激发学生的学习兴趣和相互作用。
五、学法分析
新课标准强调以学生为中心,学生作为学习的主体,教师的主要任务是帮助学生形成有效的学习策略,发展自主学习的能力。在本课教学中,教师应引导学生:
1、每个都有自己喜欢和不喜欢的事物,学会询问他人也就学会了与人和谐相处,大家应养成经常使用英语谈论的习惯,提高口语能力。
2、学习英语不是一朝一夕的事,要求学生长期练习,多听、多说、多练,只有坚持不懈才能学习好英语。
六、说教学程序。
本课主要学习句型Do you like salad?Yes,I do、 No,I don’t、 I like bananas、 I don’t like apples、 Does he/she like salad?Yes,he/ she does、 No,he/ she doesn’t、 He/ She likes apples、 He/ She doesn’t like apples、运用这些句型谈论食物及喜好
七、教学过程
1、导入设计:教师事先安排学生看一段小故事,引出Do you like …?Yes,I do、No,I don’t、
2、整体感知:
(1)充分利用图片以及实物进行直观教学,引出本课的主题—food,like
(2)呈现大量图片,并引导学生谈论图上的食物以及个人喜好
(3)检测讨论学习结果,完成la里的内容。
(4)听力检测:听录音完成lb里的内容
(5)、Pair work角色扮演。学生4人一组,用所学语言问答练习、进一步熟悉所学语言:单词及句型,训练学生口语、
(6)做练习2a和2b,进一步练习学生听力、
(7)播放另一段故事引出Does he/she like salad?Yes,he/ she does、 No,he/ she doesn’t、 He/ She likes apples、 He/ She doesn’t like apples、运用这些句型谈论食物及喜好、复习单三、
(8)给出图画,让学生谈论名人的喜好,练习单三用法
(9)用同一幅图,让学生写出句子,练习以第一人称和第三人称方式写文章、给出时间写文章并读出来,练习读写能力、
3、总结本课,巩固知识、
把主要内容重新展示,并留出HW,巩固学习成果、
七年级上册英语课件【篇3】
新目标英语七年级上册Unit5SectionA(1a-2c)教学设计
一、教材分析
1、教学内容
1)、词汇:do, have,tennis, ball,ping-pong ball, bat, soccer ball, volleyball, basketball, volleyball.2)、语言结构:A、Do you have a ping-pong ball?Yes,I do.Do you have a ping-pong bat?Not,I do not。Does she/he have a pen?Yes,she/he does
2、教材的地位及其作用
本单元的教学主要内容是:学习have的一般现在时的疑问式的肯定和否定回答,该话题与学生的日常生活紧密联系在一起,容易唤起学生的学习兴趣,这对于提高学生的综合能力很有帮助,特别是说的能力。
本单元仍在继续学习一般现在时,这是一个生活中离不开的时态,也是最基本的一个时态。新课程标准要求学生重点掌握一般现在时,这在英语中使用频率很高,学好这一时态的用法对以后其他时态的学习和交际有很大的帮助。
二、学生分析
学生现有的能力与已掌握的知识:
学生在已经学过词汇:What is this in English? What is that in English?It’s…
句型: Where is…? It’s in / on / under/…
经过前面的学习学生已经积累了一定的词汇,掌握了一定的目标语言,已经具备了一定的听说读写能力。
三、教学目标
1、语言知识
词汇:A、重点掌握表示有关各种运动球类的名词, 如basketball, soccer ball,so on
重点句型:? Do you/they have a TV? Yes,I/they do./No,I/they don’t.Does he/she have a soccer ball? Yes,he/she does./No,he/she doesn’t.2、语言技能
1)、能看着图片说;Do you/they have a TV? Yes,I/they do./No,I/they don’t.Does he/she have a soccer ball? Yes,he/she does./No,he/she doesn’t.3、学习策略、1)利用教材SectionA1a,2b所提供的图片卡片做出简单的判断。
2)通过与同学交流,学会使用一般现在时的疑问形式及肯定和否定回答。
4、情感态度、价值观
1)通过各小组的对话练习培养学生的合作精神;
2)通过学习本单元Section A,教会学生之间互相有无的主要句式.重点难点
1、Have 的一般现在时的疑问式用法;
2、Have的一般现在时的疑问句,及其肯定,否定回答;
3、简单拓展主语第三人称单数的句型。
教学手段:采用最简单的卡片图片、课本以及肢体语言。理念与思路、教法
1)采用图片进行直观教学。
2)学生在课堂教学过程中口头训练应成为本单元教学的重点内容。
教学突破:Section A重在通过使用动词have对物品的所属进行提问和回答的交流式口语活动,学习由助动词do或does引导的一般疑问句的构成以及回答。教师要善于引导学生比较行为动词的疑问句和be动词的疑问句在构成和回答上的区别,通过大量和反复地操练以达到运用自如。
四、教学过程
第一教学环节:情景创设,导入新课
教师活动 学生活动
Section A主要内容是通过使用have对物品的所属进行提问和应答,来学会使用do和does引导的一般疑问句。所以在教学中可采取问答式导人法:
掌握新单词.采用各种方法学习单词。
1、升降语调、拼读的方式记忆单词。2.检查学生记忆单词的成效。
3、学生看1a的图片,使字母和单词相对应。第二教学环节;老师和学生互动:学习掌握重要内容。
教师活动 学生活动(看图片练句型)
1.分片进行演示:I have a footba11.Do I have a football? 自己回答:Yes,I d0.再问:Do I have a basketball? 自己回答:No,I don’t.再使用其它物体和图片询问学生:Do I have…? 询问学生:Do you have…? 询问学生:…? 询问学生:Do they have…? 在学生充分掌握的第一,第二人称和第三人称 的复数。
2.学生回答:Yes,you do.No,you don’t.学生回答:Yes,I do.No,I don’t.学生回答:Yes,he/she does.No,he/she doesn’t.学生回答:Yes, they do.No,they don’t.掌握它的肯定和否定回答。
3、要求学生完成1b的听力,完成任务。
4.引导学生展开Pair work活动,完成l c部分口语交际的教学任务,学会运用助动词do进行问答,可采用师生互动带动学生互动的交流方式:
5.Pair work活动,完成l c部分口语交际的学习任务,学会运用助动词do进行问答并上台展示口语交际。
第三教学环节:合作交流,巩固提高
教师活动 学生活动
1、学生巩固练习活动,完成课堂练习和总结及笔头练习的教学任务。
2、让总结本课的 主要内容,如果不周到,教师可以补充完成。
3、习题练习,巩固课堂。问题探究与拓展活动
动词的第三人称单数形式:当句子的主语是“第三人称单数”时,即:不是I,不是you的其它单数形式时,谓语动词必须改变形式,也就是在词尾加-s或-es(同名词的复数形式),我们可以简称为“三单形式”。有些动词的变化是特殊的,如:have的三单形式是has。在构成否定句时。要在动词前加助动词don’t或doesn’t;在构成疑问句时,则要在主语前加上助动词do或does,does/doesn’t是do/don’t的第三人称单数形式。助动词后应该用动词的原型。
五、教学反思:
本单元重点学习的语法是do 和 does 引导的一般疑问句以及它们的回答方式,与此同时学习与运动有关的一些词汇。为此,在本单元我运用不同形式鼓励学生使用目标语言,在任务中体现学生的主体地位。在过程中学生可能出现一些不足,本人仍以积极的态度对待他们,逐渐地完善他们。愉快的氛围对学生的学习有很大的积极影响力。调动学生的学习兴趣和积极性至关重要,这方面,我正不断努力去做。
教无定法,教师不要为了任务活动而忽略了语言的传授。学生的信息交流要在特定的环境中进行,给他们参与的机会。任务的完成不是语言学习的结束,而是另一个高度的开端。加强学生语言的实践训练是改革的关键,要给学生机会去说、去做、去思考。
七年级上册英语课件【篇4】
新版七年级英语上册课件【1】
我说课的内容是北师大版数学七年级上册第三章的第一节课《字母能表示什么》,我主要从“教材分析”、“教法与学法分析”、“教学过程设计与说明”、“设计追求的特色”四个方面组织说课。
一、教材分析
(一)教材所处的地位
本节课北师大出版的新课程标准实验教材第三章的第一节课,在以前的学习中学生比较熟悉对具体数的操作,这是学生初次接触用较为抽象的字母来表示数,对字母表示数含义的理解有助于代数式以及方程的列出,是学习后续知识的关键。
(二)教学目标
1.知识目标:在现实情景中感受用字母表示数的意义,明确字母可以表示任何数,会用字母表示探索的规律,能用字母表示运算律和公式。
2.能力目标:经历探索数量关系,发现规律,运用字母表示规律,并通过运算验证规律的过程。
3.情感目标:一是体会字母表示数的意义,形成初步的符号感;二是进一步感受数学魅力,在学习过程中激发学生学习数学、探索数学奥妙的内在动力和外在的积极性,并在过程中培养学生的创新意识和实践能力。
(三)教学的重点、难点
1.立足本人的分析确定的:字母表示数的意义、数学规律的探索及符号表达,这些内容也是本课的难点。
2.可能基于学生个性差异、基础差异在学习过程中感觉困难的地方也是本课的难点。在教学过程中,我将认真注意,并尽力帮学生突破。
二、教法和学法分析
我校是定点的移民子女、进城务工子女就读学校,留守生在班级中占38%,学生的个性、基础能力差异很大,加上七年级学生处于小学与初中的衔接过渡初期,所以本节课我选择引导探索与分层教学相结合的方法。在新知的引出过程中,注意由浅入深,由特殊到一般地提出问题。引导学生自主探索,尤其在形成新知生长点的时候,充分发挥分层教学法的优点,帮学有余力的发挥潜能,挖掘
潜能,在先行的基础上发挥他们“先学后教”(后教就是帮助老师教,当老师的助手,在过程中达到教学相长的功效),教师抽出精力帮助学习困难的学生,帮助有“怪问题”的学生。注重时间分配,尽量做到先学在当堂,同层竞赛在当堂,异层帮辅在当堂,练习探讨在当堂、激发兴趣在当堂。
在教学过程中,关注每一学生,让每一个学生都动起来,促成学生成为学习的主人,从而发挥学生的主体作用。
三、教学过程设计及说明
(一)情景导入:利用电子白板的幕布创设问题情境(插入背景音乐,增加形象性和趣味性):“一只青蛙1张嘴,2只眼睛4条腿,1声扑通跳下水。两只青蛙2张嘴,4只眼睛8条腿,2声扑通跳下水。三只青蛙3张嘴,6只眼睛12条腿,3声扑通跳下水。6767”,让学生把这首儿歌继续唱下去,唱几句即可,然后老师提问:在这首儿歌中假如有a只青蛙,那么请同学们思考一下,应该有多少张嘴,多少眼睛多少腿,以及多少声普通跳下水?问题设计具有一定的趣味性,引出可以用字母表示数。目的是激发学生的学习欲望,体现数学来源于实际生活,数学是从人的需要中产生这一认识的基本观点。
在这个过程中,尽量发挥不同层次学生的作用,体现出学生的自主学习、自我探讨、总结交流等主体性的过程。
(二)实验操作:用电子白板拉出问题。鼓励学生用火柴棒或木棒,按照“口”、“日”、“目”搭建正方形,然后填表,找规律。按照同层独立先竞争、异层小组后合作、全班交流分享的办法进行。
填写下表:
1在处理问题的过程中,充分抓住新知的生长点做文章,前四个空是铺垫,后一个空是新知生长点。对学有余力的学生,要求把100变成10000填空。这样做既培养了独立思考、勇于探索的能力,又培养了学生的帮扶意识和合作品质,还激发了学生的进取精神。
(三)问题解决和方法交流:按照小组交流和班级分享的办法进行。展示出想到的各种方法,小组推荐代表发言,鼓励学生对发言进行诊断评价,及时提醒学生注意发言、评价有无不妥,充分发挥教师平等中的首席作用。在这个过程中,还注意数学学习氛围的打造,保持教师刻意打造学习氛围的意识。
(四)随堂练习。分层次推出练习。设置三组,一是必做题2个;二是挑战题2个;三是攻坚题4个。设计时注重了层次,必做体现了保底;挑战和攻坚有层次的观注了个性差异。在同层之间进行竞赛性的统计,控制了学生思考的松紧度。
随堂练习的评价由先行的学生负责,教师给予适当的提醒。基本按照学生先做----代表评价-----教师适当帮助的步骤进行。
(五)课堂小结:主要通过学生回忆本节课所学内容,从内容、应用、数学思想方法、获取新知的途径方面先进行小结。教师尽量不补尾巴。以免形成学生总结时注意力不集中,教师总结才听的局面,在学生总结不全面可以给足时间让学生补充,真正当好平等中的首席。
(六)布置作业:内容略。
控制时间,尽量让学生当堂完成,不加重课后负担,不降低学习的积极性。
四、设计追求的特色
在本节课的设计过程中,我注重把握了以下几点:
1.既研究了教法,也研究了学法,基本按照以学定教的思路进行设计。
2.重视了新知生长点,在新知生长点创造学生思考的问题,给足思考的空间。
3.注重了先学后教,而且尽可能让学有余力的学生去教,实现将带兵,兵促兵,兵教兵的局面。
4.发挥先进的教学手段如电子白板在教学中的辅助作用。
5.发挥学生的主体地位,摆正教师平等中的首席地位。
6.尽量做到课外不留作业,作业、练习分层安排,真正关注学生的个体差异。
7.注重创设学习氛围,激发兴趣,培养兴趣,巩固兴趣。
新版七年级英语上册课件【2】
Unit 1 Topic 3 How old are you ?
Section D
学习目标
1.学习以短文形式谈论姓名、年龄、学校、班级和电话号码等个人信息
2.能读懂短文并能从简单的名片中获得信息
3.能向大家做自我介绍
学习重点
以短文形式谈论姓名、年龄、学校、班级和电话号码
学习难点
第一人称和第三人称的转变
学习过程
(一)导入
(二)自学指导
1、预习课本P23 Part 1 ,复习书上的六个音标
2、预习课本P23 Part 2 ,分别找出Jane 和 Huang Hua 的个人信息
3、预习P23 Part 3 ,根据所给信息把空补充完整
4、背诵课本P24 Part 4a 4b
(三)问题导学 再看课本P22 Part 2 ,回答问题。
Where is Jane from ?__________________________
How old is she ?___________________________
What class is she in ? _____________________
Where is Huang Hua from ? _______________
What’s his English name ? _____________________
Are they in the same class ? ______________
(四)典题训练
(五)精讲点拨
1、They are not in the same class ,but they good friends.他们不在同一个班,但是他们是好朋友。
解析:same 意思是“相同的”,前面一定要用定冠词“the”,后面接单数名词。
but 意为“但是,可是”,起转折作用。
eg : We are in the same school ,but in different classes.我们在同一个学校,但是在不同的班级。
五.当堂检测
(一)用be动词的适当形式填空
1、---How old ________ you ?
2、----I ________ ten.3、---What _____ this ?-
4、---It _________ a pen.5、----Who ________ that ?
----She _________ Lucy.6、---What _________ these ?
----They ________ schoolbags.7、---__________ this a pen ?
----Yes , it _________.(二)单项选择
1.What’s that _______ Chinese ?
A、on B、in C、with
2.Is he ____________ English boy ?
A、a B、an C、the3、These are my _____________.A、book B、pens C、a friend4、---Is this your eraser ?----Yes ,____________.A、it is B、this is C、it’s5、They are not ________ the same class ,but they
are good friends.A、in B、on C、from
七、作业布置
(一)根据句意和首字母提示填空
1.They are in the s________ class.2、--How o________ is she ?---She is 15.3.Li Ming and Wang Fei are good f___________.4、I’m in a h_________ school.5、Is your p__________ number 3264-7853 ?
(二)选择填空
1、______ is Zhou Lan._________ phone number is 1358429764.A、Her , her B、She , her C、She , She2、What grade ______ your brother in ?
A、is B、am C、are3、---Is that a car ?---No ,____________
A、that isn’t B、that is C、it isn’t4、Nine and eleven is __________.A、thirteen B、fifteen C、twenty5、_________ are good friends.A、you ,he and I B、I ,you and he C、you and he ,I This is an English boy(男孩).His name is Jim.He is twelve.He is in my school.He and I are in the same grade.I’m in Class Three, Grade Seven, but he is in Class Four.I’m his good friend.He is my good friend, too.根据短文内容, 补全对话。
A: Excuse me, what’s his name?
B: His name is Jim.A: 6.______________________________
B: Yes.J-I-M, Jim.A: Where is he from?
B: 7.______________________________
A: How old is he?
B: 8.______________________________
A: Is he in your school?
B: 9.______________________________
A: Is he in Class Three, Grade Seven?
B: 10.______________________________
He is in Class Four, but he and I are good friends.A: Thank you.汉译英:1.布朗是他的姓氏。Brown is his ____ ____.12.那是一张地图吗
Is that ____ ____.13.它们是五辆公共汽车。
They are ____ ____.14.让我帮帮你吧。
Let ____ ____ you.15.给你。____ ____ are.(五)作业:请写一份自我介绍,内容包括姓名、年龄、国籍、班级、学校、电话号码。
七年级英语知识点
现在进行时态
概念:表示现在(说话瞬间)正在进行或发生的动作,也可以表示目前一段时间内或现阶段正在进行的活动。
结构:由be动词(am, is, are)+ 动词ing构成,其中be动词要与主语保持性数一致。
Mary is flying a kite in the park.玛丽正在公园里放风筝。
--What are you doing now? 你现在在干什么?
--I’m reading English.我正在读英语。
Are they drawing the pictures now? 他们正在画画吗?
动词现在分词是动词原形变化而来的,规则变化如下:
动词ing形式叫动词现在分词,其构成如下:
1)直接在动词后加ing
play—playing, do—doing, talk—talking, sing--singing
2)以不发音的字母e结尾的动词,先去e,再加ing
make—making, write—writing, have—having, take—taking
3)以重读闭音节结尾的动词且词尾只有一个辅音字母,应双写这个辅音字母,再加ing
run—running, stop—stopping, put—putting, swim—swimming
注意对现在进行时态的判断。判断一个英语句子用什么时态,主要看句子的时间状语,一般说来,每种时态都有与之相对应的时间状语。现在进行时表示现在(说话瞬间)正在进行或发生的动作。因此,这个时态最常用的时间状语是now;但有不少句子并没有now,只能通过提示语如look、listen等或者通过上下文来确定用现在进行时。
She is cleaning her room now.她正在打扫房间。
Look!The girl is dancing over there.看!那个女孩在那里跳舞。
--Can you go and play games with me? 你能和我们一起做游戏吗?
--Can’t you see I am doing my homework? 你没看见我正在做作业吗?
七年级上册英语课件【篇5】
一、说教材
1.教材分析
本课为听说教学课,教材内容围绕着询问职业展开,内容比较贴近日常生活,是学生比较关心的话题,易于激发学生的学习兴趣。仁爱版七年级上册的Unit3 Topic2 Section A 在本单元中起着总领下文的关键作用。本课通过谈论父母的职业,让学生从学会谈论各种职业中,掌握句型What does he/she/your…do?从而学会关心他人,同时使学生能够利用简单的英语询问职业,为下节课谈论工作的地点做铺垫。通过本课教学,进一步培养学生运用英语的能力,使学生体会到学习英语的快乐。
2.教学目标
【知识目标】
能记忆有关职业的词汇,掌握如何询问职业的句型。
【能力目标】
学生学会并能运用询问职业的句型进行对话。
【情感目标】
通过句型操练,灵活运用所学知识,谈论家庭成员及其工作,学会关心他人,热爱生活。
3. 教学重难点
重点:让学生学会关于职业的词汇,并在活动中运用单词、句型。
难点:运用询问职业的句型进行交流
二、说学情
学生年龄在12-14岁;
活泼好动,好奇心、求知欲强,喜欢展现自己;
已掌握常用的职业词汇,如teacher, student等;
具备一定的听说读写能力;沟通能力欠佳,注意力不集中。
七年级上册英语课件【篇6】
【课题】Unit1 My name’s Gina.
2. 识记本单元词汇:what, this, in, English, a, an, map, orange, jacket, key, quilt, pen, ruler, spell, please, etc.
名字______遇见______问题,难题______ 回答,答案 ______
1.my_________2.clock _________3.nice ________ 4.what ________
5. your_________ 6.hello _______7.I________ 8.you ________9.his ________
10.her ___________11.name__________12.are________13.is____________
(1.)Kate has lost(丢失) _______key. _________asked _________for help.
A.her ,he, I B. his, he ,me C. his, she, I D. her, she, me
(2)_____ plus(加) seven is thirteen?
(3)______ is her name ?
2. 写出下列英语形式。
(1):电话号码??????_______________(2):早晨好________________(3):下午好____________
3. 写出下列词的英语意思:
1). 早晨__________2).下午_________3).晚上___________4).谢谢_________
5).名字________6).好的________ or_________
【预习反思】:你还有什么问题吗?(Do you have any problems?)
Step2 精讲点拨: What’s your name ? 你叫什么名字?句中的your可根据问对象换成his、her等物主代词。What’s his name ? (翻译) ___________________.
Step3 Pairwork 1: Student A: What’s your name ?
Pairwork 2: Student A: Hello! I’m Mary.
Step4 Summary : 1)向别人作自我介绍是通常用My name is + 自己的名字/ I’m +自己的名字
2)将下列单词分类 I , he, my, his, her, she, it, its
人称代词: ___________________________
物主代词: ____________________________
(一)、单项选择;
1. What’s ______ name? A. he B. I C. her D. you
2. ________she Lucy? A. Am B. Is C. are D. be
3. ________is Li Lei.________English is good
A. He’s ; His B. His; He C. He; His D.You; Your
4.下列有一个发音与其他发音不同的是______.
5. ------What’ your name ? ----------__________
A. Yes B. Thanks C. Tom D. Fine, thank you
(二)、补全对话。
1. A:How do you do? B:_________________
3. A: Good evening, Frank!
B:________________, Eric!
4. A: ________________, Dale!
B: Good afternoon, Alice!
5. A: _____________________________?
七年级上册英语课件【篇7】
一、Teaching materials:
Unit 3 Language in use (Module 10 Life history)
二、Targets for this perio d:
To summarize and consolidate past simple questions and negative sentences and the new vocabulary
三、Key points:
Key vocabulary— in, a lot
Key structures—Did you do…? Yes, I did. / No, I didn’t.
We didn’t do ….
四、Teaching methods:
Task-based approach, formal and interactive approach
五、Teaching aids
Blackboard, handouts
六、Teaching arrangements:
Step One To translate the sentences into English
1. 当你是个小男孩时,你骑自行车去上学吗?
Did you ride a bike to school when you were a boy?
2. 他是世界上最出名的作家之一。
He is one of the most famous wri ters in the world.
3. 七、八月份,我和哥哥拜访了住在海边的阿姨。
In July and August, my brother and I visited my aunt near the sea.
4. 莎士比亚是一个戏剧家和诗人
Shakespeare is a writer of plays and poems.
5. 1950年人们不使用移动电话和 计算机。
In 1950 people didn’t use cell phones or computer.
6. 当他在十四岁毕业时他决定当一名演员。
He decided to be an actor when he finished school at the age of f ourteen.
7. 你爹妈什么时候结婚的?
When did your mother and father marry?
8. 二十八岁时他迁往伦敦并加入一家剧团。
At twenty-eight he moved to London and joined a theatre company.
9. 他成了一名成功的演员并开始写戏剧。
He became a successful actor and started writing plays.
10. 你仍然能看到他的英文版和许多其他语言版的剧本。
You still see his plays in English and in many other languages.
Step Two To c omplete the con versation (Activity 1)
1. Students finish it by themselves.
2. Check the answers in pairs.
3. Two student act out the conversation.
4. Detailed explanation:
1) in +原料 / 颜色
e.g: He is in black.
He wrote a diary in ink. Cp: He wrote a diary with a pen.
2) a lot = very much ; often
e.g: He learned a lot when he was a child.
Step Three To use the conversation in Activity 1 to write about your parents. (Activity 3)
1. Students finish it by themselves.
2. Students read aloud their passage in the front of the classroom.
(Students should pay attention to the tense)
Example: My parents didn’t use computers at school when they were young. They watched TV with plain color and few channels. Sometimes they played f ootball and tennis in the park.
Step Four To learn about l ife in the past (Around the world)
1. Students read the passage and answer questions.
1) Did people use computers in 1950? No, they didn’t.
2) Was there satellite TV or Internet in the past? No, there wasn’t.
3) Why did people travel by bike or by bus? Because Cars were expensive.
4) Did they go to other countries on holiday? NO, they didn’t.
2. Students read it aloud.
Step Five To answer the questions according to the actual life ( Activity 5)
1. Students do it by themselves.
2. Studen ts work in pairs.
Step Six To finish all the exercises in Workbook
Homework:
1. To review Module 10 and copy all the words and expressions in P159
2. To finish Module 10, 点中典 & 轻巧夺冠
七年级上册英语课件【篇8】
新目标英语七年级上册Unit5教学设计
原州四中
牛平平
核心提示:教材分析
1、教学内容 1)、词汇:have,soccer,ball,tennis racket,ping-pong ball,volleyball,basketball sport,bat,2)、语言结构:A、Do you have a ping-pong ball?Yes,I do。Do you have a ping-pon
教材分析
1、教学内容
1)、词汇:have,soccer,ball,tennis racket,ping-pong ball,volleyball,basketball,bat,2)、语言结构:A、Do you have a ping-pong ball?Yes,I do。Do you have a ping-pong bat?No,I don’t。
2、教材的地位及其作用
本单元的教学主要内容是:学习have的一般现在时的疑问式的肯定和否定回答,该话题与学生的日常生活紧密联系在一起,容易唤起学生的学习兴趣,这对于提高学生的综合能力很有帮助,特别是说的能力。
本单元仍在继续学习一般现在时,这是一个生活中离不开的时态,也是最基本的一个时态。新课程标准要求学生重点掌握一般现在时,这在英语中使用频率很高,学好这一时态的用法对以后其他时态的学习和交际有很大的帮助。
二、学生分析
学生现有的能力与已掌握的知识:
学生在已经学过词汇:What is this ? What is that? 句型: Where is…? It’s in / on / under/…
经过前面的学习学生已经积累了一定的词汇,掌握了一定的目标语,已经具备了一定的听说读写能力。
三、教学目标
1、语言知识
词汇:A、重点掌握表示有关各种运动球类的名词, 如basketball, soccer ball,so on
重点句型:? Do you have a TV? Yes,I do./No,I don’t.2、语言技能
1)、能看着图片说;Do you have a TV? Yes,I do./No,I don’t.3、学习策略
1)、利用老师所提供的图片卡片做出简单的判断。
2)、通过与同学交流,学会使用一般现在时的疑问形式及肯定和否定回答。
4、情感态度
1)通过各小组的对话练习培养学生的合作精神; 2)通过学习本单元,让学生之间能够用所学句型互相交流。
重点难点
1、Have 的一般现在时的疑问式用法;
2、Have的一般现在时的疑问句,及其肯定,否定回答;教学手段:采用多媒体教学。教学突破:Section A重在通过使用动词have对物品的所属进行提问和回答的交流式口语活动,学习由助动词do引导的一般疑问句的构成以及回答。教师要善于引导学生比较行为动词的疑问句和be动词的疑问句在构成和回答上的区别,通过大量和反复地操练以达到运用自如。
四、教学流程
一、第一教学环节:情景创设,导入新课 教师活动 学生活动
Section A主要内容是通过使用have对物品的所属进行提问和应答,来学会使用do引导的一般疑问句。所以在教学中可采取问答式导人法:
掌握新单词.采用各种方法学习单词。
1、升降语调、拼读、接龙和肢体的方式记忆单词。
2.检查学生记忆单词的成效。
3、学生看1a的图片,使字母和单词相对应。
第二教学环节;老师和学生互动:学习掌握重要内容。
教师活动 学生活动(看图片练句型)分片进行演示:I have a footba1 1.Do I have a football? 自己回答:Yes,I do. 再问:Do I have a basketball? 自己回答:No,I don’t.再使用其它物体和图片询问学生:Do I have…? 询问学生:Do you have…? 询问学生:…?
2.要求学生完成1b的听力,达到教学应完成的任务。
3.引导学生展开Pair work活动,完成lc部分口语交际的教学任务,学会运用助动词do进行问答,可采用师生互动带动学生互动的交流方式: 4.Pair work活动,完成lc部分口语交际的学习任务,学会运用助动词do进行问答并上台展示口语交际。
三、第三教学环节:合作交流,巩固提高
教师活动 学生活动
1、学生巩固练习活动,完成课堂练习和总结及笔头练习的教学任务。
2、让总结本课的 主要内容,如果不周到,教师可以补充完成。
七年级上册英语课件【篇9】
课题: Comic strips Welcome to the unit(第一课时)
学习目标:
1.引入有关地点和交通的话题。
2.谈论参观访问和交通方式。 3.辨别方位。
认识路__________________ 爬上山 ____________
跟随我__________________ 在北京的西南_______________
下来 __________________ 乘地铁去市中心____________________
不要害怕 ________________ 不得不 ________________
一次春游________________ 进行一次远足________________
一、根据地理位置,用适当的方位词填空。
1. Guangzhou is in the ____________ of China.
2.Beijing is in the ______________ of China.
3.Shanghai is in the ______________of China
4. Kunming is in the _______________ of China.
5. Harbin is in the ________________ of China.
jiang is in the _________________ of China.
二、根据汉语提示及所给词的适当形式完成下列句子。
1. We are _________(害怕) of tigers.
2. My daughter likes ___________ (跟随) me to go shopping.
七年级上册英语课件【篇10】
新目标英语七年级上册Unit5第一课时教学反思
康川学校
卢光萍
本节课重点学习的语法是do 和 does 引导的一般疑问句以及它们的回答方式,与此同时学习与运动有关的一些词汇。在本节课我运用不同形式鼓励学生使用目标语言,在任务中体现学生的主体地位。在过程中学生可能出现一些错误,本人就以积极的态度对待他们,愉快的氛围对学生的学习有很大的积极影响力。首先要调动学生的学习兴趣和积极性,我努力在这方面去做,不足的请各位多提宝贵意见。学生的信息交流要在特定的环境中进行,给他们参与的机会。任务的完成不是语言学习的结束,而是另一个高度的开端。加强学生语言的实践是改革的关键,要给学生机会去说、去做、去思考。一篇好的教学设计应争取在课堂中得到更好的效果。自己教学的一节课,回顾反思一下自己在执教时的切身体会或疏漏,想一想学生上课时的闪光点或困惑,从而积累教学经验和吸取教训,不断地改进课堂教学和提高自己的教学水平。非常感谢学校给我这次好的网络学习机会,真是受益匪浅,在今后的教学过程当中,我会借着这次机会所学到的知识不断地提高自己的业务水平。
七年级上册英语课件【篇11】
新目标英语七年级上册Unit3 SectionA说课稿
谢燕娥 尊敬的各位评委老师:
你们好!今天我说课的题目是新目标英语七年级上册第三单元Unit3 This is my sister.中的SectionA部分,整个说课我将分成六个大部分进行讲述:即 教材分析、学情分析、教法、学法、教学过程 及 板书设计。
第一板块:教材分析
(一)、说教材
《新目标英语》教材的语言教育理念是:知识用于行动,强调“语言应用”,培养“创新实践能力”,发展“学习策略”。它采用任务型语言教学模式。教材中每单元都设计一个或几个与该单元话题有关的任务,让学生在完成任务的过程中,使用英语获取信息,用英语进行交流,培养运用英语解决实际问题的能力。本课是新目标英语七年级上册第三单元第一课时,教材以This is my sister.为中心话题,围绕着谈论有关家庭成员的用语,并学会询问别人的情况,介绍自己的家庭,谈论自己的情感。并在此任务中认识到名词复数的概念及其运用。
(二)、教学目标
1.知识目标:a)学习单词: mother.father.brother.sister.these.are.those 等b)学习并掌握句型:Is this your sister?No, it isn’t./ Yes, it is.This is my friend.These are my friends.That is my brother.Those are my brothers.2.能力目标:通过Introduce people和Identify people使学生学会介绍他人和
识别他人,掌握基本This is/ That is...These are/ Those are…
等句型,培养学生实际交际的能力。
3.情感目标:通过介绍家人和朋友,对学生进行亲情教育,使他们学会感恩。
(三)、教学重难点
1.重点;学习重点单词,句型和语法点: This is my friend.These are my
friends.That is my brother.Those are my brothers.2.难点:名词复数形式及其正确的运用
第二板块:学情分析
七年级的学生正处于青春期发育期,他们有较高的求知欲和表现欲,希望自己的表现能得到同学和老师的认可。且该阶段学生已具备初步的语言表达能力和较强的记忆力与模拟能力。对他们所熟悉的话题学生的爱好会更浓,而本单元的话题正符合这一特点,所以我就设计任务型的课堂活动,让学生人人参与,增强他们学习的积极性和学习的自信心。
第三板块:说教法
新教材重视以人为本,强调素质教育。在教学中,要注意发挥学生的主体作用,把空间留给学生。抓住初中生活泼好动,表现欲强的心理特点,课堂上我设计了大量听、说、读、写的训练,启发学生动脑思考,鼓励学生大胆开口,畅所欲言,尽可能运用英语表达实际意义,从而最大限度地调动学生的积极性和主动性。教学中,我主要采用任务型教学法,情景结合教学法,分层法和通过学习五步教学法,精讲巧练,由浅入深,由易到难,由已知到未知,循序渐近地深化教学内容。展开以教师为主导,以学生为主体的师生双边活动。
第四板块:学法指导
1.引导学生用小组合作学生的方式来完成任务型教学所设计的各项活动。全班分为7个小组,每组6-7人,各组英语水平相当,并引入竞争机制。培养学生的实际能力,发展学生的合作能力。
2.采取的教学手段是多媒体辅助教学,充分利用农村中小学现代远程教育资源,自制课件,用生动的课件调动学生的感官,进行听说读写的训练。培养学生的观察力和想象力,发展学生的思维能力。
第五板块:教学过程
Step 1.Leading-in 创设情景,导入新课
出示一些实物,如钢笔、钥匙、尺子等,用下面句型引导学生与同伴之
间进行交谈。复习前面学过的句型,为新授作好铺垫。
S1: Is this your pen?-----Yes, it is.S2:Is that her ruler?-----No, it isn’t.It’s my ruler.Step 2.Presentation 新课讲解,呈现教学内容
我先出示一张照片,通过创设情景,师生对话,引出新知识: e.g.:T:What is this ?------Ss: It’s a photo.T:Is this your photo?-------Ss: No, it isn’t.-------
T:It’s not your photo.It’s my photo.And this is my sister.从而引出本课时重点句型: This is my sister.并在此基础上讲解“this
is…”是用来向对方介绍他人的。同时运用这句型“This is…”进行教学新单词:mother , father , sister , brother , grandfather 等所有家庭成员。让学生先对本课所要讲的内容有个初步的感知,激发学生进一步学习的动机。Step 3.Practicing反复操练,巩固运用
为了调动学生的积极性,主动深化短时记忆中的信息,并逐步向长时
记忆迈进、发展。我将利用多媒体生动活泼呈现多张家庭成员图片。让学生将单词与图中人物匹配,认识家庭成员。并学会使用This / That is my …和 These are / Those are … 介绍家人和朋友,巩固知识、操练知识。在此同时,要注意与讲解名词的复数形式 以及 让学生能够正确的运用。
Step 4.Listening and doing口语操练,加深印象
学生通过前面的学习,已经对新的知识形成了初步的新知识结构,但
在名词复数结构上还存在着模糊点,这时通过一系列的综合练习可以巩固、发展及完善学生的知识结构。
a)通过播放1b录音,学生听,模仿说,完成任务,巩固语言材料,培养
学生听说能力。
b)让学生准备几分钟,运用本课所学的句型“This / That is …”和“These /
Those are …”对1a 中戴夫家庭成员进行介绍。进一步巩固本课的重难点。
c)对学生进行分组,分别完成2c对话之后。让学生用自己的照片,编出自
己的对话,到前面进行对话表演。转换角色,练习对话。
Step nsolidating课堂练习,巩固知识
在学生已在大脑中构建新的认知结构基础上,提供适当的课堂练习,不仅能让学生在实践中自我学习、自我改进、达到自我完善;而且能够充分地让学生体会到“知识的获得并不只是单方面的‘输入’过程,更重要的是知识的‘输出’” 也就是说能够根据外部实际情况对新知识准确地提取并加以运用。
因此我会出示一些与本课语言点相关的选择题和情景对话,要求学生当场完成。课堂练习的目的在于检查学生掌握知识的情况以便教师发现学生缺漏,及时补充。同时也有助于进一步巩固,加强对本课内容的理解和运用。Step 6.Homework课外作业
1.掌握所学词汇。
2.向同学介绍家人或朋友。
第六板块:板书设计
板书反映出一节课内容的知识体系,精心设计的板书,它既有利于教师帮助学生的思路,又有利于学生掌握教学的重难点,从而提高课堂教学的效果。也有助于把学生思维中已有的知识作重调整,让散乱的知识边的条理清楚,同时也让学生学会把所学的知识进行归纳、概括。不仅可以促使学生积极思考,而且对于提高学生的分析、比较、判断的能力,有积极的作用,还使学生获得的知识不容易遗忘。
Section AUnit 3
New words:Grammars:
mother, father, sister, brother,Is this your sister?
parent,grandfather,grandmother,-----Yes, it is./ No, it isn’t.friend, these, are, those.This / That is my friend.These / Those are my friends.以上就是我说课的整个内容,谢谢。
七年级上册英语课件【篇12】
七年级上册英语Unit7第一课时教学设计
宜君县第二中学 王娟
一、设计思路
本节课教授的词汇主要是服饰类的,课型属于听说课。所以在课前先营造一种轻松的学习氛围,教唱一首英语歌曲,让学生尽快地融入进课堂,期间还有pair work,groupwork,把学生分成两两小组或四人小组,互相对话。这样的活动要进行两次,可以提供给学生充分的时间进行交流。
二、教材分析
本节课是第七单元的第一课时,学生在前一单元初步学习完有关食物的英语知识之后,进一步地在本单元学习有关服饰的知识。而本课时是第一课时,所授的知识点应该浅显易懂,不应该太难。本课时围绕着几个关于服饰的词汇和两个询问价钱的句型展开。
三、教学目标
(一)教学知识点
(1)New words:T-shirt,sweater,bag,hat,skirt,socks,shorts,pants,shoes,(2)Questions and answers:How much is/are…?It’s/They are…dollars.(二)能力训练要求
(1)通过师生对话,生生对话等一系列活动,提高学生实际运用英语的能力。(2)体会合作学习所带来的快乐。
(三)情感与价值观要求
通过学生互相帮助,互相学习,体验集体荣誉感和成就感,发展合作精神。
四、教学重点和难点 重点:
(1)学会重点词汇的发音,单复数形式的掌握。(2)学会询问价钱的英语句型及其回答。难点:
(1)表示大小,颜色的形容词同时出现在名词前时,该如何摆放。(2)听力2a前,如何充分铺垫,以便于学生跟上录音速度。
五、教学策略与手段(1)师生对话,生生对话。(2)充分运用现代教育技术手段。
六、教学过程
(一)、课前热身:教唱英语歌曲 color song Who is wearing yellow today?
yellow today, yellow today Who is wearing yellow today?
yellow today.Who is wearing red today?
red today, red today Who is wearing red today?
red today Who is wearing green today?
green today, green today Who is wearing green today?
green today Who is wearing blue today?
blue today, blue today Who is wearing blue today?
blue today Who is wearing black today?
black today, black today Who is wearing black today?
black today Who is wearing white today?
white today, white today Who is wearing white today?
white today Who is wearing pink today?
pink today, pink today Who is wearing pink today?
pink today 设计意图:为了给学生营造一种轻松愉快的学习氛围,尽快融入到所教知识中去,也可以为接下来的颜色的教学作铺垫。
(二)、导入新课:
(1)媒体图片,教授学生新单词。T-shirt,sweater,bag,hat,skirt,socks,shorts,pants,shoes,然后完成书本P41的活动1a.设计意图:这一步是为了让学生为接下来的口语活动打下基础,有话可说。
(2)生走进一家虚拟的服装店,让学生根据所学单词,进行结对活动,学会提问:How much is/are…? 以及回答:It’s/They’re…dollars.设计意图:目的是给学生创设半真实的情景,在这样的情景下呈现新的句型能让学生更容易理解和接受。在结对活动之前,先让个别学生操练重点句型以作示范,以使全班同学都能理解并准确地操练新的语言点。
3(3)卡片教授颜色:red,green,yellow,orange,white,black,blue…
设计意图:为了教会学生用一个或多个形容词来描述物品,使其语言更加丰富。
(4)服饰大调查: ①以四人一组为单位,对本组同学所穿服装颜色和价格进行问答② 根据回答做记录并填好表格;③挑选几位同学向全班汇报记录的情况。
设计意图:在一堂课结束的时候安排这么一个活动,目的是让学生把本堂课学过的知识点串联起来,能使他们更加自由地交谈,并且有更多地时间运用所学的新单词,新句型进行对话,通过观察还能提高他们的审美观。
(三)、课堂小结
(1)今天这堂课你学到了什么?(2)你有那些收获?请同学们谈谈。
(四)、课后作业:两人或三人合作编一个在商店购物的对话.
七年级上册英语课件【篇13】
Ⅰ.教学准备
1.教师:录音机、磁带、图片、多媒体课件。
2.学生:准备一份班级的课程表;制作一份英语课程表。
Ⅱ.教学目标
1.知识目标:
(1)单词:favorite,subject,science,music,math,Chinese,geography,history
(2)句型:—What's your favorite subject?—My favorite subject is art.
2.能力目标:通过本课学习,掌握一些词汇、句型等语言知识,能够运用所学词汇、句型和他人交流,提高英语口语表达能力。
3.情感目标:通过互相谈论喜欢的学科,增进同学之间的了解和友情。
4.文化意识:了解英语国家学生的学习生活,增强跨文化交际的意识。
Ⅲ.教学重点
1.单词:favorite,subject,science,geography,history
2.句型:—What's your favorite subject?—My favorite subject is science.
Ⅳ.教学难点
1.熟练运用所学的词汇、句型表达和交流信息。
2.正确运用本课中所学的表示品质的形容词描述事物。
Ⅴ.教学步骤
Step 1:Leadin
建议1:教师播放各学科上课的画面,问学生分别是什么学科,引出各学科的名称,最后做一个总结。
For example:
T:Class!Please look at the picture.What subject is it?
S1:It's Chinese.
S2:It's math.
S3:It's geography.
S4:It's science.
Then the teacher has a summary:Chinese,m ath,geography,science...
建议2:教师问学生现在学习的学科有哪些,让学生列举出来,从而引出各学科的名称,最后总结一下。
For example:
T:Class!How many subjects are you learning now?What subjects are they?
S1:We are learning Chinese,math,English...
S2:And science,music,history...
Then call some other students to have a sup plement.In the end,let the the students give a summary.
建议3:教师问学生现在学的科目有哪些,找一两个学生来回答。然后教师 和学生做一个看图猜谜游戏。让学生看图,猜猜是什 么学科,最后让学生将各学科全部总结一下。
For example:
T:Class!What subjects are you learning now?Can you say out?
S1:Chinese,math,English...
S2:P.E...history...
T:Class!Please look at each picture.What subject is it?Can you gue ss?
Let the students look and guess.In the end,let the students have a summary.
Step 2:Present ation
建议:教师引导学生将1a中的各学科名称与图画进行配对。
For example:
T:Class!Look at 1a and the pictures.Can you match the words with the right picture?
Call one or two individuals to check the answers.
Step 3:Practice
建议1:教师问学生是否能准确流利地读出1a中的单词,找几名学生朗读一遍。对于读错的单词,教师纠正其发音错误,并领读两遍。然后让全班同学齐读两遍。
For example:
T:Class!Can you read the words in 1a correctly?
Then call some individuals to read.
S1:P.E.,art,science,music,math,Chinese,geography,history.
S2:P.E.,art,science,music,math,Chinese,geography,history.
Then the teacher corrects their pronunciation mistakes,and then has a leading reading.
In the end,let all the students read the words collectively.
建议2:教师领读两遍,然后将全班同学分成三组或四组,组织一次朗读比赛,看哪一组读得好。最后进行一个看图抢答游戏,看谁说得又对又快,奖励说得又对又快的学生。
For example:
T:Class!Let's practice readi ng the words.Please read the words after me.
Then the teacher has a leading reading.The students follow the teacher.
T:Class!Now,let's play a guessing game.Look at the pictures and rush to say out the subjects.Award the students who said correctly and quickly.
Step 4:Leadin
建议:教师问学生是否能熟练说出1a中的单词,告诉学生将进行一次听力测验,以检验学生是否完全掌握1a中的单词。
For example:
T:Class!Have you grasped the words of the subjects in 1a?Now let's have a test.
Then let the students listen to the conversations in 1b.
Step 5:Consolidation
建议:教师将听力原文投放在屏幕上,把重点单词去掉。让学生再听一遍录音,填出单词,补全对话。
For example:
T:Class!Look at the listening text.Listen to the tape again,write out the missing words.
After listening,call one or two individuals to check the answers.See how well they did.
Step 6:Practice
建议1:教师让学生大声读一遍听力原文,问学生是否有不理解的地方。如果有,教师给予点拨讲解。
For example:
T:Class!Please read the listening text aloud.
Then let the students read for some time.
T:Class!Do you have anything that you don't understand?
If they have,have a brief explanation.
建议2:让学生熟读几遍1b中的对话,找几名学生朗读对话,看看读得怎么样。教师给予语音、语调、语气等方面的指导和纠正。然后将全班学生分成两大组,练习对话,看看哪一组说得好。
For example:
T:Class!Please read the conversations aloud by yourselves.Then I'll ask some of you to read.
After reading,the teacher corrects th e mistakes about their pronunciation.And tell the students what tones and intonations they should use.
T:Class!Let's practice the conversations between groups.See which group will say better.
Group A:What's your favorite subject?
Group B:My favorite subject is...
Group A:Why do you like...?
Group B:Because it's...
建议3:教师让学生自己熟读几遍对话,然后让学生两人合作表演对话。
For example:
T:Class!First,please read the conversations aloud by yourselves.Next,please practice performing the conversations in pairs.Then I'll call some of you to act out.
S1:What's your favorite subject?
S2:My favorite subject is...
S1:Why do you like...?
S2:Because it's...
Step 7:Leadin
建议:由步骤6谈论的内容自然过渡到问学生最喜欢什么学科以及喜欢的原因。
For example:
T:Class!Just now we talked about some people's favorite subjects.
What about you?What's your favorite subject?Can you talk about it?
S1:My favorite subject is...
T:Why do you like...?
S1:Because it's...
Then call some individuals to practice with the teacher in the same way.
Step 8:Practice
建议1:通过步骤7的导入,引出要练习的句型。让学生两人合作编对话,并进行表演。比一比哪一组说得好。
For example:
T:Class!Can you make a similar dialogue in pairs?Then I'll call some of you to act out.
Then let the students work in pairs to make a dialogue.
S1:What's your favorite subject?
S2:My favorite subject is...
S1:Why do you like...?
S2:Because it's...
建议2:做一个“找朋友”的游戏。让学生在班内走动,互相询问喜欢什么学科,找到与自己喜欢的科目相同的人。
For example:
T:Class!Let's play a game—Find friends who likes the same subject with you!
You can leave your seats and go around the class.Ask everyone what his/her favorite subject is.The one who likes the same subject with you is just your friend.
S1:What's your favorite subject?
S2:My favorite subject is...
S1:What's your favorite subject?
S3:My favorite subject is...
S1:What's your favorite subject?
S4:My favorite subject is...
Step 9:Consolidation
建议:教师让学生做个陈述报告,陈述自己喜欢什么学科以及喜欢的理由。
For example:
T:Class!Now let's have a report about your favorite subject and the reason why you like it.You can report like following:
Hello!Everyone!My name is...I like some subjects,such as...But my favorite subject is...Because it's...
Let the students pra ctice it for some time.Then call some students to act out.
Step 10:Task
建议:教师让学生在小组内做采访调查。询问组内每个成员喜欢什么学科以及喜欢的原因。然后找几组同学进行采访表演。
For example:
T:Class!Now in your group,have an interview and make a survey.Ask the members of your group what their favorite subjects are,and the reasons why they like them.
Then call some groups to perform their interview.
S1:Hello!I'm a reporter.Can I ask you some questions?
S2:Yes.
S1:What's your favorite subject?
S2:My favorite subject is...
S1:Why do you like...?
S2:Because it's...
Step 11:Summary
建议:教师让学生自己总结本节课所学的内容,包括单词和句型。
For example:
T:Class!Let's sum up what we have learned in this class.What words did we learn?
Ss:Favorite,subject,science,music,math,Chinese,geography,history.
T:What sentences did we learn?
Ss:What's your favorite subject?My favorite subject is art.
Step 12:Homework
1.和你的同伴讨论各自喜欢什么学科以及喜欢的原因,编成对话并表演。
对话模式:
S1:What's your favorite subject?
S2:My favorite subject is...
S1:Why do you like...?
S2:Because it's...
2.调查你周围的同学,问问他们喜欢什么学科。作好记录,制成表格。
Names Favorite subjects
板书设计
Unit 9 My favorite subject is science.
Section A 1a1c
Words Sentences
favorite,subject,science,music,math,Chinese,geography,history —What's your favorite subject?
—My favori te subject is science.
备课资料
知识讲解
1.表示学科的名词,有几个单词首字母要大写,因为它们是专有名词。例如:Chinese,English,P.E.
2.—What's your favorite subject?
—My favorite subject is art.
favorite表示“最喜欢的”。
—What's your favorite sport?—My favorite sp ort is basketball.
—What's your favorite food?—My favorite food is hamburger.
3. What's your favorite subject?(同义句)
→What subject do you like best?
My favorite subject is art.(同义句)
→ I like art best.
七年级上册英语课件【篇14】
人教版七年级上册英语课件
Unit12 My favorite subject is science课件.rarUnit12 My favorite subject is science课件3.rarUnit12 My favorite subject is science课件2.rarUnit11 What time do you go to school课件.rarUnit11 What time do you go to school课件3.rarUnit11 What time do you go to school课件2.rarUnit10 Can you play the guitar课件.rarUnit10 Can you play the guitar课件3.rarUnit10 Can you play the guitar课件2.rarUnit9 Do you want to go to a movie课件.rarUnit9 Do you want to go to a movie课件3.rarUnit9 Do you want to go to a movie课件2.rarUnit8 When is your birthday PPT课件.rarUnit8 When is your birthday PPT课件3.rarUnit8 When is your birthday PPT课件2.rarUnit7 How much are these pants课件.rarUnit7 How much are these pants课件3.rarUnit7 How much are these pants课件2.rarUnit6 Do you like bananas PPT课件.rarUnit6 Do you like bananas PPT课件2.rar
Unit5 Do you have a soccer ball课件.rarUnit5 Do you have a soccer ball课件2.rarUnit4 Where's my backpack PPT课件.rarUnit4 Where's my backpack PPT课件2.rarUnit3 This is my sister PPT课件.rarUnit3 This is my sister PPT课件2.rarUnit2 Is this your pencil PPT课件.rarUnit2 Is this your pencil PPT课件2.rarUnit1 My name's Gina PPT课件.rar
英语七年级上册课件(通用12篇)
老师在上课前需要有教案课件,老师在写教案课件的时候不能敷衍了事。教案编写是教师进行教学投入的重要支持,要写好教案课件有没有好的范文可借鉴呢?编辑为您提供了关于“英语七年级上册课件”的最全面信息,敬请浏览本文内容!
英语七年级上册课件(篇1)
Unit7 How much are these socks? 第一课时Section A(1a-2c)教学反思
薛玉鹏
本节课的多媒体课件内容比较丰富,且图片鲜活,紧紧围绕Learn how to ask about the prices话题,进行展开谈论如何用英语询问物品的价格,即培养了学生学习英语的兴趣,又营造了一个积极生动的学习氛围。本节课主要运用目标语言-How much is…?-It’s …dollars.-How much are…? – They’re…dollars.让学生充分练习对话,进一步掌握语言目标。
这节课主要有两个重点:
第一个重点:运用图片形象直观的学习服饰类词汇;第二个重点:通过How much进行对话训练询问物品的价格。
1.通过本节课的教学,我在教的过程中摆脱了注入式,满堂灌,学生以接受式学习为主,教师讲,学生听的教学方式,在教的过程中,我采用任务型教学的特点,注重培养学生的学习能力,引导学生自学,并在自学中善于质疑,探究,以及小组合作等形式完成任务。
2.通过本节课的教学,我在教学过程中首先让学生通过图片让学生感知学习词汇,进一步学习单词;其次,通过
A: What’s this ? B: It’s a sweater.A: What color is it ? B: It’s yellow.A: How much is it ? B: It’s 10 dollars.此对话进行语言目标训练,让学生在情境中学习,以便能形成初步的语言感知,然后创设真实情景,让学生们交流并表达。
3.在本节课中充分地体现了学生的主体性,学生从自学到求知到探索到掌握知识的整个过程中,兴趣浓厚,热情高涨,而且表现地非常积极踊跃,由于学生有许多探讨的机会和空间,所以回答问题的正确率较高,并且学得轻松自如。
4.本节课的教学,我觉得有以下几个方面需要改进:首先,我应该合理搭配时间,有些环节用时较多,以致其他环节用时较少。其次,本节课主要谈论价格,可以课前老师或学生选些实物并标上价格在课堂上让学生训练,这样更切合实际,很容易让学生进入语言教学中。最后,在学生探索问题时,对学生进行引导的技巧方面有待改进,只是死板板的教读与训练。
英语七年级上册课件(篇2)
尊敬的各位老师:
大家好!
今天我说课的`内容是七年级英语上册第五单元第一课时,这一课时可分为三部分,一是要求掌握一些球类运动的名词,英语单词是学好英语的基础,只有掌握大量的英语单词,在丰富知识的同时,才能提高应用语言的能力;第二部分是听力训练;第三部分是口语训练Do you have a ……句型。下面我将从以下几个方面阐述说课内容。
一、教材分析
本教材倡导语言教学的交互性和实用性,为学生提出了自然的、有意义的语言环境,本单元主要是学习动词have的一般现在时的用法:Let引导的祈使句及形容词的使用,一般现在时是第五第六两个单元的重难点、学会第三人称单数形式的灵活使用,同时也复习了第三单元名词复数的变化规则,谈论对各种球类运动的看法,从而引出形容词的用法,用层层递进的方式,逐步扩大和加深,具有很强的逻辑性,整体感。
鉴于以上的分析,为更好地实现目标教学,进而提高课堂效益,我结合教材特点及学生实际情况为这一节课拟定了以下目标。
1、知识目标帮助学生掌握三会、四会单词如have soccer ball tennis racket=bat ping-pong volleyball basketball does让学生掌握句型的灵活运用
2、能力目标让学习形成良好的听说习惯,同时让学生了解一些与球类运动相关的信息
3、德育目标通过向学生展示一些体育明星的图片,让学生热爱运动、热爱祖国、激发学生的爱国荣誉感。
教学重点:本课的第一部分是一幅展示新功能在实际生活中运用的图画,图中引出了本课在操练新知识所需用到的重点单词,新的句型也呈现在人物头上的气泡中,本课的重点是让学生学会使用Do you have……的句型。
教学难点:句型Do you have……的肯定回答及否定回答
二、教法分析
根据教材需要,采取多种教学方法交互使用权用,精讲巧练,由浅入深、由易到难,提高学生的学习兴趣,展开循序渐进地深化教学内容,展开以教师为主导、以学生为主体师生双边活动,主要以直观教学、交际性教学和任务型教学,贯穿整个教学过程,增加了直观性和趣味性,激发学生兴趣,活跃课堂气氛,提高教学效果。
三、学法指导
我所采用的教法有助于学生掌握以下学法
1、科学地储备大量的学生感兴趣的课外知识,学生掌握了感受兴趣的丰富的课外知识才能进行良好、积极的语言交流。
2、掌握大量的语法知识、学生要交流就必须了解语言规律,丰富词汇、熟悉语法规则,学会由各个话题而展开的交际内容,这样学生的知识才记得深刻,灵活度大
3、及时巩固、反复记忆
教师在课堂上所讲的语言难点、重点、学生应及时整理、再次认识并积极使用。
4、养成听的习惯
学生要经常听录音,听教师讲英语,听同学们讲英语、这对学习英语是很有好处的,
5、积极操练,重在口头
在课堂上,学生要积极参与教师设计的每个教学活动,要大胆开口、课后和同学进行及时交流,把书本知识变成自己的知识和语言,只有多练才能实现脱口说英语的目的。
四、教学过程设计
我的课堂的整体设计分四个主要步骤进行,即新授、听力、巩固、和作业
第一步:新授
1、出示几幅图来出现我们这节课将会学习的球类运动的名词以及相应的名星:在教学单词的过程中,用What is this in English和How do you spell it句型和学生进行双边活动,掌握本课所学习的新单词
2、学习新句型,通过图,来学习I have a soccer ball……句型,并让学生多读、多理解I have……句型
3、让学生整体复习巩固一下我们这节课所学习的新单词,让学生会读,并掌握拼写。
4、让学生以唱的形式复习新单词及I have……句型,如Soccer ball . Soccer ball.I have a Soccer ball.
为活跃课堂气氛,请个别学生为下列句子谱曲并唱如basketball. basketball.I have a basketball.这一部分学生比较感兴趣,学生可随意发挥,也可根据自己所熟悉的歌曲的歌谱来唱出这些句子。
5、新授I have……句型的否定句,一般疑问句、肯定回答和否定回答。
第二步听力训练
请学生听录音,把所听到的单词圈起来,然后检查答案
请学生听第二遍,并跟着读,回答下列三个问题
Do you have a computer game?
Do you have a baseball bat?
Do you have a ping-pong bat?
第三步巩固
1、通过猜猜我有什么的活动。巩固句型Do you have……及回答
2、请学生以唱的形式练一练这对话
第四步作业布置
运用下面的单词编写三组Do you have……问句并作答
Volleyball football basketball
五、板书设计
DO you have a soccer ball
New words:
Soccer ball basketball volleyball baseball football tennis ping-pong bat=racket
I have a soccer ball:
Do you have a soccer ball?
Yes I do. No I don’t
六、本节课教学效果的预测
本节课设计本着讲练结合的要求,把教学的内容目标化、课堂教学交际化、而且在设计充分考虑学生的现状,保证所有学生能够积极参与,能重视知识传授与能力培养相结合,循序渐进、因材施教、符合以教师为主导、学生为主体、以会学生为主旨、以练为主线的四主要求。
七、评价手段
课堂教学中主要使用的形成性评价,其主要目的不是为了选拨少数优秀学生,而是为了挖掘学生的学习潜能,提高学生的学习兴趣,在课堂教学中,我便用的评价形式有两种:学生互评和教师评价。
英语七年级上册课件(篇3)
七年级上册英语第二单元This is my sister.说课稿
各位评委各位老师,大家上午好!我是……。今天,很荣幸能站在这里为大家呈现我的一堂课并接受大家的指点。接下来,我将从以下六个部分来阐述我的课程。
第一部分 说教材
今天我上课的内容是人教版新目标七年级英语上册第二单元This is my sister第一课时.本节课既是本单元的基本语言内容,又为后面知识的扩展和综合语言运用奠定坚实的基础。因此,上好本课时,既让知识的学习有一定的延续性,又为后面的教学做好铺垫,对完成本单元的英语教学具有重要的战略意义。另外,根据国家课程标准的要求,里面就有关于“家庭与朋友”的话题;课标还要求学生在中学毕业时要达到五级目标,而五级里也有关于“家庭、朋友与周围的人”的话题。可见“家庭”话题贯穿始终。本单元作为初中阶段对家庭话题的起始单元则更应该让学生掌握好最基本的介绍家人、确认人物的句式,为以后的学习打好基础。同时,家庭成员是学生最亲最熟悉的人,这个话题会给学生带来认同感和自信心,提高学生投入其中的兴趣。
1.教学目标
知识目标:
1).能正确使用家庭成员的称谓:mother, father, parent, grandfather, grandmother, grandparent, brother, sister.2).能正确使用介绍人物的句型:This / That is….These / Those are….3).能正确使用确定人物的句型:Who is he/ she? He /She is….Is she / he/ this/ that…? Yes,she/ he/it is.No, she/ he/it isn’t.4).能发现名词单数和复数形式的不同,能在对话中开始有意识地使用名词的复数形式,以及搭配一致的谓语。
能力目标:
1).能听懂介绍人物和确定人物的句型的对话。
2).能用家庭成员称谓以及介绍人物和确定人物的句型来看图说话和两两对话。
3).能用目标句型角色扮演和续写对话。
情感目标:
能意识到家庭成员和朋友是自己一生的财富,要懂得珍惜。教学重点
1).掌握本课时表示家庭成员称谓的单词。
2).能正确使用介绍人物的句型:This / That is….These / Those are….3).能正确使用确定人物的句型:Who is he/ she? He /She is….Is she / he/ this/ that…? Yes,she/ he/it is.No, she/ he/it isn’t.教学难点
1).能发现名词单数和复数形式的不同,能在对话中正确地使用名词的复数形式,以及搭配一致的谓语。
2).在this/that作主语的疑问句中,正确地用it指代回答。
第二部分 说学情
初一学生对英语既陌生又感到新鲜好奇,他们希望通过学好这门新课程来提高整体知识水平或得到他人的认可,并渴望将英语用到生活中来增加乐趣。但由于学习态度和学习习惯的不同,随着英语学习内容的增加,两级分化开始出现。唤醒学生的兴趣,增强他们的自信心,小组合作学习显得尤为重要。同时,还要适度拓展知识,满足优等生的需要。
第三部分 说教法
“新课标”强调课程要从学生的学习兴趣、生活经验和认知水平出发,倡导体验、实践参与、合作和交流的学习方式和任务型的教学途径,发展学生的综合语言运用能力,根据本班学生情况,我将在教学中利用简笔画,多媒体等,采取任务型教学模式,运用情景教学法,结合听说法、contest guessing、小组合作,循序渐进进行教学,激发学生的兴趣,培养学生综合运用语言的能力,学以致用。
教学用具:简笔画,多媒体课件,录音机
第四部分 说学法
1、合作学习。本课时将在课堂活动中将学生分成六人一组的学习小组,在活动中互相交流、互相探讨,相互合作,从而获得知识、技能和情感体验,发展他们的能力。
2.主动学习。通过创设情境和有意义的任务活动,激发学生的学习热情,发挥他们自己的主观能动性,把被动学习变为主动学习。
第五部分 说流程 Step 1.Warning up
首先,用所学的How are you?来进行简单的问候,这样既把学生带入到英语学习的环境又巩固了所学知识。然后,将学生的注意力吸引到屏幕上,介绍这是我的朋友,这些是我的朋友们。friend是已学内容,能够明白。然后出示我的图片问学生Who is she,学生回答是我,然后说你们知道了我的好朋友,想不想见见我的家人的照片呢,今天我就来将我的家人介绍给大家,学习完这堂课,同学们下次就能用英语将你的家人朋友介绍给别人啦,由此引入标题This is my sister.Step 2.Presentation
呈现“父亲”图片,介绍“This is my father.”同时将这句话板书在黑板上。带学生拼读这个单词的音标,然后F-A-T-H-E-R,father这样领读这个单词。然后以同样的方式呈现“That is my mother.”“These are my parents.””This is my grandmother.””That is my grandfather.””Those are my grandparents.””This is my brother.””That is my sister.”将新单词写在黑板左边,句子结构This/That is...,These/Those are...写在黑板中间。
然后请同学们以开火车的方式翻译刚刚出现过的单词,教师进行及时更正。
接下来进行反馈。让八个学生举手扮演教师本人,来对刚刚出现的图片用This/That is...,These/Those are...进行介绍.这样初步了解学生对单词的掌握情况,及初步接触使用目标语言。
然后分组比赛,将全班学生分为ABC三大组,和教师进行英汉互译游戏,教师说一个单词,学生起立翻译,第一个站起来翻译正确的学生可为本组争取一分。这样可以极大调动全班学生的积极性,同时巩固了单词。然后,教师一张一张出示单词卡片,教师点名翻译,这样来检验后排的学生是否掌握了单词。翻译对的学生加一分。
接下来到了课本内容环节。“同学们,现在你们已经知道了我的家人,而且还知道家庭成员的英语称谓啦,你们看,这是Dave,你们知道他的家人分别是哪个吗?”由此过渡到活动1a。“请看图,who is Dave’s mother?”学生说字母a,”是的,所以我们把字母a写在mother后面的横线上。”请同学们将其他单词和图片配对,这个环节学生独立完成。教师在班内走动,了解学生的进度并提供必要的帮助。然后,核对答案。
然后,指着图片介绍“Dave is introducing his family to his friend, Linhai.让我们来听一听他们的对话内容,并帮忙圈出他所介绍的人吧!”播放录音机,第一次,请同学们认真听,不写,第二次,请同学们完成任务。然后请一个学生说出他的答案,再播放录音一次,和全班学生一起核对答案。最后,请同学们打开课本69页,跟读录音一遍,要求注意语音语调。然后把学生的注意力吸引到语法上,强调目标语言的句子结构及单复数。
Step 3.Practice
“接下来我们来看看1c中的对话,聪明的同学们发现这个对话和图片中的对话有什么联系吗?”“是的,他们就是同一个对话。”“我们回顾一下,这个对话和刚才录音中的对话有什么联系吗?”“是的,这个对话就是录音中对话的一部分。”“让我们全班齐读一遍。”全班齐读。然后请两个学生扮演Dave和Lin Hai示范读一遍。接着,请同学们二人一组进行练习,并轮流介绍1a图片中的其他成员。最后,请三组同学说出他们的对话。
接下来,实践练习部分。教师出示自己画的家庭简笔画,对自己的家庭成员进行介绍,然后请同学们画各自的简笔画,然后介绍给小组成员。这个环节画简笔画部分需要两分钟有点难以掌控,但会非常有趣,同时让学生增加对家人的认识。最后邀请两个学生带着简笔画向全班介绍。
Step nsolidation
将学生的注意力吸引到屏幕上。“我们来做一个猜一猜的游戏,这个女孩是玲玲,猜一猜她在和谁说话呢?”同时板书句型“Who is that?””Is that her...”在黑板上。这个环节只有两个图片,学生会有一种意犹未尽的感觉,借用这个感觉将它布置为家庭作业,请同学们一个扮演玲玲,拿着照片对话,另一个学生来猜。
Step 5.Summary
“是的,玲玲和她的家庭玩得很开心。那么,请同学们想一想,什么是family?”请学生思考,帮助找出答案。然后播放背景音乐《相亲相爱的一家人》,介绍自己怯于介绍自己父亲的故事,引导学生思考“不要想家人为你做了什么,想想你为家人做了什么”,进行感情引导,任何时间任何场所都要勇敢自信地介绍自己的家人,因为他们是我们最重要的人。同时,也要珍惜身边的亲人朋友。今天我们学习了家庭成员的称谓,及如何介绍他人。
Step 6.Homework
课后和同学完成刚才那个猜一猜的游戏,并预习下一课时内容。
第六部分 板书设计Blackboard Design
Unit 2 This is my sister.father, mother, parents,grandfather,grandmother,grandparents,brother,sister
--This/That is...--These/Those are...--Who is he/she?
--He/She is...--Is she/he/this/that...?
--Yes, she/he/it is...No,she/he/it is...
英语七年级上册课件(篇4)
新目标英语七年级上册Unit5第一课时教学反思
康川学校
卢光萍
本节课重点学习的语法是do 和 does 引导的一般疑问句以及它们的回答方式,与此同时学习与运动有关的一些词汇。在本节课我运用不同形式鼓励学生使用目标语言,在任务中体现学生的主体地位。在过程中学生可能出现一些错误,本人就以积极的态度对待他们,愉快的氛围对学生的学习有很大的积极影响力。首先要调动学生的学习兴趣和积极性,我努力在这方面去做,不足的请各位多提宝贵意见。学生的信息交流要在特定的环境中进行,给他们参与的机会。任务的完成不是语言学习的结束,而是另一个高度的开端。加强学生语言的实践是改革的关键,要给学生机会去说、去做、去思考。一篇好的教学设计应争取在课堂中得到更好的效果。自己教学的一节课,回顾反思一下自己在执教时的切身体会或疏漏,想一想学生上课时的闪光点或困惑,从而积累教学经验和吸取教训,不断地改进课堂教学和提高自己的教学水平。非常感谢学校给我这次好的网络学习机会,真是受益匪浅,在今后的教学过程当中,我会借着这次机会所学到的知识不断地提高自己的业务水平。
英语七年级上册课件(篇5)
Unit 4 Don't eat in class.
Section A (1a-2d)
一、教学目标:
1. 语言知识目标:
1) 能掌握以下单词:rules, arrive, late, hall, dinning hall, listen, listen to, fight, sorry
2) 能掌握以下句型:
① Don't eat in class.
② You must be on time.
③ Eat in the dining hall.
2. 学会用英语表达一些标志的含义。
3. 熟练使用目标语言谈论对某些规章制度(校规、家规等)的看法
二、教学重难点
1. 教学重点:
1) 肯定祈使句是省略掉主语的原形动词开头;
2) 否定祈使句则是在肯定祈使句前加上“don’t”。
3) 情态动词must及have to在用法上的区别。
2. 教学难点:
掌握祈使句的用法,并能听懂、会说一些简单的祈使句。
三、教学过程
Ⅰ. Warming-up and revision
用祈使句请学生们完成一系列动作:
Please stand up/ sit down. Close the door, please. Look at me and listen to me.
Don’t open your books. Don’t talk. Let’s begin our class.
Ⅱ. 1a
T: Now, Look at the picture on your textbook. Each of the students is breaking one of these rules. Please finish 1a.
Ⅳ. Listening
Now let’s listen! What rules are these students breaking? Write the numbers after names?
Ⅴ. Pair work
Read the dialogue in 1cand work in pairs.
Ⅵ. Listening
1. First, let's read the sentences in 2a together. Now, let's listen to the recording. Check the activities Alan and Cindy talk about.
2. Work on 2b: Listen to the recording again. Can Alan and Cindy do these activities? Circle can or can't above.
Ⅶ. Pair work
1. Suppose you are Alan and your partner is Cindy. Talk about the rules in 2a.
2. Let some students come to the front and act out the conversations.
Ⅷ. Role-play
Read the conversation and find some rules in this school. Ss read the conversations and find the answers to this question.
( Don't be late for school. Don't bring music players to school. You always have to wear the school uniform. You have to be quiet in the library. )
Homework:
1. Remember the new words and expressions.
2. 完成下列句型转换试题
1)I can play computer games on weekends.(一般疑问句)
_________________________________? Yes, ____________.
2) He has to wear uniform.(变否定句) He _____ _____ _____ wear uniform.
3) I have to wear sneakers for gym class.(一般疑问句)
_____ you ____ ____ wear sneakers for gym class? Yes, I ____.
4) They have to wash clothes.(提问) ____ do they have ____ ____?
5) You can’t go out on school nights.(换一种表达) _______ go out on school nights.
6) Don’t talk in class.(同上) No _________.
Section A (Grammar Focus-3c)
教学重难点
1. 教学重点:
1) 继续学习使用目标语言谈论对某些规章制度(校规、家规等)的看法
2) 通过不同方式的练习方式来学会用英语表达一些标志的含义。
3) 运用祈使句来表达一些规章和制度。
2. 教学难点:
1)总结用祈使句、情态动词can、must及have to来表达各种规章制度;
2) 能用所学的知识来制定一些简单的规章制度。
教学过程
Ⅰ. Warming- up and revision
Ⅱ. Grammar Focus.
1. 学生阅读Grammar Focus中的句子,然后做填空练习。
① 不要在楼道里跑。_______________________
② 不要打架。 ____________________
③ 有什么规则? ___________________
④ 我们必须按时上课。 ____________________
⑤ 我们可以在教室里吃东西吗?____________________
⑥ 不能。但我们可以在餐厅里吃东西。___________________
⑦ 我们可以在教室里带帽子吗?____________________
2. Ss finish off the sentences and check the answers by themselves.
Ⅲ. Writing
Look at 3a. Do you know the meaning of these pictures? Can you write the rules for the school library?
Ss discuss the pictures and make some rules. Let some Ss read their rules aloud. Check the answers with the class.
(Don't listen to music in the library. Don't eat or drink in the library. Don't take photos in the library. )
Ⅳ. Practice
Work on 3b: Use the words to make questions about the rules. Then write answers according to your school. For example: Be quiet? (she/have to/ in the library) Does she have to be quiet in the library? Yes, she does.
2. 注意: have to虽是情态动词,但其在句子中与谓语动词共同构成句子时,其一般疑问句应用助动词do或does来帮助构成;而情态动词can则直接提前构成一般疑问句式。
3. Ss work by themselves and try to write the sentences on the workbook.
4. Ss work in pairs. Ask and answer the sentences.
Ⅴ. Game
Ss work in groups and discuss what rules are in their school. Write down their rules on the work. Let some Ss read their rules aloud. See whose school is the coolest?
Ⅵ. Exercises
1. If time is enough, do some more exercises on the screen.
Homework
1. Read the sentences in Grammar Focus.
2. Make some rules at home.
板书设计
Section B 1a-2c
教学重难点
1. 能掌握以下单词:out, go out, dish, do the dishes, night, before, dirty, kitchen, more, noisy, relax, read, terrible, feel, strict, be strict with, remember, follow, follow the rules, luck
2. 能掌握以下句型:
① Don't leave the dirty dishes in the kitchen.
② I can't relax either.
③ I must read a book before I can watch TV.
④ I have to help mom make breakfast.
3. 理解must, have to/ can/can't的用法
三、教学过程
Ⅰ. Warming- up and revision
Check the homework. Let some Ss read their home rules.
Ⅱ. Presentation
1. Show some pictures on the big screen and let Ss learn the new words and expressions.
2. 学生看着1a部分的图片
学生朗读1部分的“rules”,并将图片a~h的序号填写在1b这些规则前的方框中。
Check the answers with the class.
Ⅲ. Listening
1. Tell Ss they'll listen to the recording about Dave's house rules. Listen and put an× for things Dave can't do and a √for things he has to do.
2. Play the recording for the Ss to listen and check.
Ⅳ. Listening
Now let's work on 1c. Now first, let's read the phrases aloud together. Explain the meaning of the phrases if necessary.
Play the recording three times for the Ss to listen and write the phrases in the chart in 1b.
Check the answers:
Ⅴ. Group work
Divide the Ss into groups to talk about Dave's home rules. Make a list of Dave's house rules. Ⅵ. Reading
1. Fast reading: Read the letter and find the answer to this question:
What does Molly feel about the rules?
Ss read the letter and find the answer to this question. (she feels terrible.)
2. Careful reading: Read the letter again and underline the rules for Molly. Check the answers with the class. (Let some Ss read their answers aloud. Let other Ss add some rules. )
3. Careful reading
1) Read Dr. Know's letter and answer this question: What does she think of the school and home rules? Let one student read out his/her answer.
(She thinks parents and schools are sometimes strict, but they make rules to help us. We have to follow them. )
Ⅶ. Reading
1. Read the letter again and complete the sentences with have to/ must, can or can't.
2. 提示: have to与must的用法:
1)must表示一种主观的需要,而have to表示一种客观的需要,意思是“不得不”。如: I have to attend an important meeting this afternoon.
今天下午我不得不参加一个重要的会议。
Mother is out, so I have to look after the shop.
妈妈不在家,因此我不得不照看商店。
2)have to的否定形式是don’t have to, 相当于needn’t。如:
They don’t have to buy a computer at present.
他们目前没有必要买电脑。
Homework
1. Remember the new words and expressions in this period.
2. Ask Ss write down Molly's rules at home and at school.
英语七年级上册课件(篇6)
人教版英语七年级上册
Unit7 How much are these socks?
Section A(1a-2e)湛江市霞山职业高级中学 蔡景茜
一、教材分析
本节课是新目标英语七年级上册unit 7 How much are these socks?第一课时,以Shopping为主线,通过对本课的学习,让学生学会用英语谈论服装的颜色、尺寸和价格,学生运用所学语言,模拟在商场售货和购物。教学内容简单且富有生活情趣,有利于激发学生的参与意识和好奇心理。
二、教学目标 1.知识目标:
词汇:掌握有关服装、尺寸和颜色的单词 句型:(1)--How much is …?--It’s….(2)--How much are …?--They’re….2.能力目标:学会询问价格及使用购物用语
3.情感目标:树立节约用钱合理消费的正确消费观念 学习重点:学会使用询问价格的句型,并能正确回答 学习难点: 区分服装的单复数
三、学情分析
抓住七年级学生活泼、好动、好胜心强的特点,引进小组竞争机制,倡导其参与活动。在教学中努力营造宽松、民主、和谐的教学氛围,鼓励他们大胆尝试,保护他们的自尊心和积极性。
四、教法分析
1.情景引入法:利用多媒体创设情景,引入新知识,吸引学生注意力,使他们对即将学习的新知识产生好奇。2.听说法:对目标语言进行反复操练,以达到灵活运用的目的。
3.任务型教学法:设计一系列的任务活动,让学生在完成任务的过程中掌握目标语言。
五、学法分析 1.分组合作学习。
2.‚为用而学,用中学,学了就用‛:本课时的目标语言是询问物品的价格,与学生实际生活联系紧密,所以应该充分利用创造的情景和实物给与学生练习英语口语的机会。
六、教学过程 Step1 Warming up Show a picture T: I’m very happy these days because Nov 11 online shopping carnival is coming soon.I want to buy a lot of clothes.Can you help me put them into the shopping cart? 【设计意图】通过双十一购物狂欢节引入新课,使学生在欢快自然的气氛中不知不觉进入教学,激发他们的兴趣和热情,活跃课堂气氛,并为本课任务的开展做热身准备。Step 2 Presentation 1.Present the new words about the picture of a sweater T: Look!What’s this?
Ss: It’s a sweater.In the same way, learn the other new words about clothes.Match the words with the things in the picture, and then check the answers together.2.Present the words about size: big, small, long, short.3.Present the words about colors.4.Present the monetary unit of yuan and dollar 【设计意图】通过大量的图片引入,直观地呈现新单词,能吸引学生的注意力,活跃学生的思维,激起学生的求知欲,让学生在真实的语境中理解单词。Step 3 Listening 1.Listen to the conversations and circle the things you hear, and then check the answers.2.Listen again and fill in the price tag, and then check the answers.【设计意图】通过师生互动的方式,引导学生看书上的六幅插图,听音圈物品,核对答案;再听录音,填价签,通过这项操练,锻炼学生获取信息的能力,在听力中使用目标语言,为下一个任务做准备。Step 4 Practice 1.Present the new sentence patterns: ‚How much is /are…? It’s/They’re …‛
2.Get the students to practice the dialogues in pairs.【设计意图】通过呈现询问价格的句型,让学生总结‚How
much is / are…? It’s / They’re…‛ 的特点:单数用is ,复数用are,并通过结对操练加以巩固。Step 5 Read and act 1.Let the students try to fill in the blanks in the conversation, read and act it out.2.Translate the sentences into English.【设计意图】通过补充对话中所缺的单词和句子,进一步熟悉购物时所需的交际用语,为下一任务做准备。Step 6 Consolidation Scene play: Thanksgiving Day is coming, please buy some clothes for your friends.【设计意图】通过‚shopping‛这个生活平台,学生不仅可以在愉快的氛围中运用本节课所学询问价钱等语言,而且使学习的过程变得生动有趣,这一活动将课堂气氛推向高潮。Step 7 let’s be a doctor Get the students to correct some wrong sentences.【设计意图】通过易错点的呈现和改正,学生能更好地掌握知识点。
Step 8 Summary and Homework 1.Summarize what we have learned in this lesson 2.Homework: write a dialogue about shopping 【设计意图】通过鼓励学生小结本课的收获,培养他们自主学习的习惯。本作业与本节课的教学目标相匹配,既帮助学生巩固了已学语言材料,又提高学生写作的能力。
教师用一长一短的pants和shorts呈现long和short,用一大一小的sweater呈现big和small, 并让学生跟着老师做手势。
[教学思路] 通过猜图游戏引入,能吸引学生的注意力,活
跃学生的思维,激起学生的求知欲,使学生能愉快地参与课堂活动,用实物和肌体语言,直观地呈现big,small , long and short等形容词,让学生在真实的语境中理解单词。Show some pictures, get the students to practice the new sentence patterns: ‚How much is / are…? It is / They are…‛ Step3、教授、练习新句型,完成活动1c 将dollar与人民币单位yuan相比较,注意dollar的单复数变化。
此环节中结合图片设计师生对话、结对活动、小组活动等任务,让学生分小组竞赛,练习巩固新句型。在练习的过程中,将重点句型How much is it?发散为How much are they?重点掌握单复数在此句型中的变化。Step4.综合运用
How much is that red hat? It’s 6 dollars.How much are your white trousers?
They are 10 dollars.加大句子难度继续操练,巩固新词汇和句型。
此环节将表示颜色的形容词带入操练句型中,并结合学生穿的毛衣、裤子、身边的尺子、书包、铅笔、橡皮擦擦等物品让学生自己编对话。
Step5、总结回顾
1、词汇:T-shirt, sweater, skirt, jacket, socks, shoes, trousers, shorts
2、句型:--How much is this T-shirt?--It’s 7
dollars.--How much are these socks?--They are 2 dollars.Homework: Ask about prices of your friend’s clothing, and write down your conversations.询问你朋友衣物的价格,并将你们的对话写下来。Step6、板书设计
Unit 7 How much are these socks?(Section A 1a ~2d)Clothing jacket A: How much is this T-shirt? a pair of socks B: It’s seven dollars.two pairs of trousers A: How much are these socks? Shorts shoes skirt sweater
B: They are two dollars.(一)教材分析
本节课是义务教育课程标准实验教科书英语新目标‚Go for it‛七年级上册unit 7 How much are these pants?的第一课时。本节课是新课引入,教学内容和教学重点就是通过学习section A(1a—2c),认识并初步掌握谈论衣物,询问价格这一情景中的运用。教学内容简单且富有生活情趣,有利于激发学生的参与意识和好奇心理,更主要的是学生通过对本课的学习,让学生学会用英语谈论服装的颜色和价格,学
生运用所学语言,可以模拟在商场售货和购物。第一课时的引入在整个单元中起到了抛砖引玉的作用,同时也是一座桥梁,是正确引导学生由说到写的第一步。因此,本节课的教学重点就落在反复熟练地运用语言上,通过大量的口头交际,为第二课的教学做好扎实的准备。
(二)教学目标
根据新课标的教学理念,从素质教育的要求出发,结合本课的教学内容和学生的语言水平,本节课的核心任务是让学生学会用英语谈论服装的颜色和价格,并可以模拟在商场里售货和购物。学生要达到以下五个目标:
语言知识目标:掌握本课书的重点词汇、语言结构。
语言技能目标:学会谈论衣服的名称,颜色和价格。
情感态度目标:通过创设人文情景,学生亲自感受和体验,使语言学以致用,激发学生的学习积极性,培养他们的自主学习,合作学习,善于学习的习惯,并让他们在实践活动中体验成功。
学习策略目标:能对所学内容主动练习和实践,提高合作意识和自主学习能力。
文化意识目标:培养学生实际运用英语能力,使学生进一步
明白语言也是文化,扩展他们的文化视野,增强他们的跨文化交际的意识和能力。学生上完本节课后,学会用英语谈论服装的颜色和价格。
(三)学生分析
①初一学生有着学习英语的浓厚兴趣和愿望,乐于参与多种调查、采访、表演等实践活动。到学期后段,学生已具备了一定的英语基础,并在unit 5 Do you have a soccer ball?和unit 6 Do you like bananas?中进行过有关调查活动、设计过野炊菜单、外出活动安排表;有过寻宝、建立俱乐部、给父母准备生日礼物等英语实践活动的体验。
②本班大部分学生有较为明确的英语学习动机和积极主动的学习态度,能积极和他人合作,相互帮助,共同完成学习任务。有不少学生表达较艰难,因此,在位置安排上,应把他们平均分配到各组,让好的学生带动他们学习,设计任务时应易到难、难易适中,教师在活动过程中经常跟他们交流,给予帮助和鼓励。
(四)设计理念
为了每位学生的发展是课程改革的核心。在本课中一共设计了三个任务:‚从认识物品‛到‚谈论价格‛,再到‚现场购物‛实现了由浅入深,由已知到未知,由知识向能力的过渡,让学生在活动中学英语。同时也着重于能力的培养和思维的
扩展,如小组合作能力、口头表达能力等。通过作业的布置,使课堂内外任务相随,能有效提高学生的英语水平,特别是培养学生的语言运用能力和动手能力。
孩子们是教育的重要资源、是动力之源、能源之库。本节课主要依靠学生,让学生进行自主学习,由于孩子们爱表现自己,通过现场购物这一任务,让孩子们学会创新、学会配合,连成绩不好的孩子也会大大方方地说上几句英语,这一活动将课堂气氛推向最高潮,孩子们学到了知识,急于即时运用。让孩子们在实际语言材料中感知,在课堂上享受着学习的快乐。
(五)教学过程
根据任务型教学模式,我将教学过程设计如下:
Step 1 Warming up
(Two minutes)
1、Sing an English song.2、Greetings.Who is wearing yellow today? Yellow today , yellow today.Who is wearing yellow today? Yellow today.①Black
②White
Green
⑤Blue
③Red
④[教学思路]通过Sing a song of color 引入新课,使学生在欢快自然的气氛中不知不觉进入教学,激发他们的兴趣和热情,活跃课堂气氛,并为本课任务的开展做热身准备。
Step 2 Presentation
(Seven minutes)
1、present the new clothing words.T: Boys and girls , I thought LingShui is very hot.But today it is cold , you see , I am just in a blouse now.I feel so cold.What should I do ? Oh, I must go to the shop to buy some clothes.教师布置任务:What am I going to buy ? Can you guess?
学生回答:毛衣∕裤子。
(逐渐展示毛衣的完整图片)
T:Oh!It is a sweater.Read after me ‘‘sweater‛.Ss: ‘‘Sweater‛.(Then show another picture with a boy and a woman come to the clothes shop ,What are they going to buy ?Can you guess?)
T:(Pointing to the boy)
What is LiLei going to buy ?
Ss: 裤子、短裤、短袜和鞋子。
T: Excellent!He is going to buy pants, shorts, socks and shoes.Read after me ‘‘pants ,shorts, socks and shoes‛.Ss:
‘‘Pants , Shorts, Socks and Shoes‛.T:
(Pointing to the woman)
What about his Chinese teacher Miss Li ?
Ss: She is going to buy a sweater and a T—shirt.T: It is very clever of you to say so!
2、Present: big , small, long, short.教师用一长一短的pants和shorts呈现long和short,用一大一小的sweater呈现big和small, 并让学生跟着老师做手势。
[教学思路] 通过猜图游戏引入,能吸引学生的注意力,活跃学生的思维,激起学生的求知欲,使学生能愉快地参与课堂活动,用实物和肌体语言,直观地呈现big,small , long and short等形容词,让学生在真实的语境中理解单词。
Step 3 practice and present‚How much is /are…? It is/They are …‛。(Six minutes)
1、教师先通过多媒体呈现短裤、男衬衣、毛衣等图片,鼓励学生说出相应物品的名称,由复习衣物名称导入How much is/are ……? It is /They are 等句型。
T:(Pointing to the sweater)What is this in English ?
Ss: It is a sweater.T: What color is it ?
Ss: It is red.T: How much is the red sweater ?
Ss: …(学生可能不知所云,教师快速点击鼠标,一张8元人民币的价签已挂在毛衣上。)
T:It is 8 Yuan , Read after me ‚It is 8 yuan‛.Ss:‚It is 8 Yuan..‛
T:You are so intelligent , and I think it is 3 dollars.(教师快速点击鼠标,挂上3美元的价签,从而引出生词dollar.)
教师教读几遍后,快速在裤子、短袜、鞋等服装上挂上价签,反复让学生练习How much is…? It is…的句型。
2、教师通过多媒体呈现两件挂有7美元价签的pants和三件挂有9美元价签的shorts问学生,由教‚How much is…? It is…‛过度到教‚How much are…? They are…‛.T:How much are these pants?
Ss:They are seven dollars.学生回答时可能想不到dollar需加s ,教师可通过dollar 与 yuan的货币学习,讲解人民币和美元的不同写法及用法,并简单介绍汇率的概念。
[教学思路]通过鼓励学生说出相应的衣物名称引出目标语言‚How much is are…?It is / They are…,‛产生信息沟,学生有交流的动机和兴趣,兴趣是最好的老师,在新课
呈现时,以兴趣为出发点,通过图片及信息沟激发学生的兴趣。同时,在特定的语境中引出生词dollar ,做到了‚词不离句‛让学生有意义地学习单词。
Step 4 Group work(Six minutes)
①T:I like shopping very much.Do you like shopping? Now come with me to the clothing shop again.Go over how to say them in English and how to buy them.Boys and girls , are you ready? Ss:Ok.T:This is a sweater.(学生重复说a sweater ,并用手拼写sweater.)
T:What color is it?
Ss:It is red.(并用手拼写red)
T:How much is the red sweater?
Ss:It is eight dollars.通过实物图,教师提问,学生集体回答,由单数名词到复数名词,反复操练新句型。
②Then , students play a guessing game:
T:How much is the red sweater /are the white shoes ?
Can you guess?
Ss:Is it /Are they 3 dollars?
T:No , it is / they are move expensive / cheaper.Well done!You are right.[教学思路]利用多媒体动画,给学生提供明确,真实的语言信息,把表示衣物名称、颜色、大小、长短的新单词和句型‚How much is / are…? It is / They are…‛融合在一起进行操练。接着,考虑到学生有一定的基础,如果单纯看图机械操练,虽使用了target language ,但学生兴趣不大,仍是无意义操练,于是设计了‚猜衣物价格‛游戏,极大地调动了学生的积极性和主动性,也使本课教学目标中的重、难点得到进一步的巩固。
Step 5 Listening(Seven minutes)1、1c练习对话
先让学生齐读1c,接着让学生分组角色,变换角色,反复运用衣物名称、颜色、大小、长短的新单词和句型进行自由操
练,然后教师检查几组同学的操练情况,目的是保证他们能正确而迅速地说出新语言,最后总结句型‚How mach is / are…? It is / They are…‛ 的特点:单数用is ,复数用are.2、2a,听对话,圈出你听到的物品。3、2b,再听一遍录音并填写价签。
[教学思路]通过师生互动的方式,引导学生看书上的六幅插图,复习服装名称及‚How much is / are…?‛句型,然后听音圈物品,核对答案;再听录音,填价签;第三遍听录音,写出对话中衣物颜色及名称的单词,通过这项操练,锻炼学生获取信息的能力,在听力中使用目标语言,为下一个任务做准备。
Step 6 Consolidation(Ten minutes)
任务活动:赠送生日礼物
教师创设情景:今天是Ann的生日,她的几位好朋友要去购买服装、鞋帽作为礼物送给她,5分钟内,看哪小组购买的服装最经济实惠。学生从小组为单位,模拟在商场购物。
①教师先和一名学生一道示范对话。
②学生四人一组,自己编对话表演,教师巡视帮助解决困难。
③成果汇报以给过生日的同学赠送生日礼物的形式呈现,并评出最佳小组。
[教学思路]通过‚shopping‛这个生活平台,学生不仅可以在愉快的氛围中运用本节课所学询问价钱等语言,而且使学习的过程变得生动有趣,这一活动将课堂气氛推向最高潮。
Step 7 Summary and Homework(Three minutes)
①先以小组为单位进行讨论,总结出这节课有什么收获,学会了什么,作自由发言。
②教师呈现本节课的重点内容。
③在布置家庭作业时,教师设计了一个简单的书面练习,课后写一段购物活动中的对话,以巩固本节课的语言知识。
④教师用一句Are you happy ? 来了解学生在这节课上开心与否来做为评价方式,让学生在愉快的气氛中结束学习。
[教学思路]通过鼓励学生小结本课的收获,培养他们自主学习的习惯。本作业与本节课的教学目标相匹配,既帮助学生巩固了已学语言材料,又提高学生写的能力。
英语七年级上册课件(篇7)
人教版英语七年级上册Unit7 How much are these socks? Section A 1a-1c说课稿
新堡初级中学
石勇亮
一、教材分析
1.教材的地位、作用及前后联系:
新目标英语七年级上册第7单元第一课时(1a-1c)。
话题:询问价格,贴近学生的日常生活。
与Starter Unit3辨认颜色以及Unit 6谈论好恶联系紧密,学习询问价格的同时可以复习巩固之前的知识。
2.教学内容:
课题:How much are these socks ? 话题:“ask about prices”。目标语言:
--How much is „?
--it’s„
--How much are „?
--They are„
3.教学目标 ①知识目标
词汇:socks
shorts sweater trousers
jacket
skirt 句型:--How much is this T-shirt?
--It’s seven dollars.--How much are these socks?
--They are two dollars..②能力目标:掌握用how much„句型来询问价格,让学生能够利用简单的英语进行购物,培养学生的听说读写能力。③情感目标:
(1)树立正确的消费观念,养成节约用钱的生活习惯;(2)知道人民币与美元的差别,了解中西方的文化差异。4.教学重点与难点
我把名词单复数的应用和如何在现实生活中询问东西的价格确定为本节课的重点与难点。为了突破难点,教学中利用了大量的图片、实物,给学生提供非常直观的感性认识。
二、学情分析
农村学生学英语起步晚,怕犯错。在教学中努力营造宽松、民主、和谐的教学氛围,积极鼓励他们大胆尝试,保护他们的自尊心和积极性。抓住七年级学生活泼、好动、好胜心强的特点,引进小组竞争机制,倡导其参与活动。
三、教法分析
1、情景引入法:利用多媒体创设情景,引入新知。吸引学生注意力,使他们对即将学习的新知识产生好奇。
2、听说法:对目标语言进行反复操练,以达到灵活运用的目的。
3、任务型教学法:设计一系列的任务活动,让学生在完成任务的过程中掌握目标语言。
四、学法分析 1.分组合作学习。2.“为用而学,用中学,学了就用”:本课时的目标语言是询问事物的价格,与学生实际生活联系紧密,所以应该充分利用创造的情景和实物给与学生练习英语口语的机会。
五、教学过程设计
Step1、Warm up and Lead in:
1、创设情境,引入新单词
socks shorts sweater T-shirt trousers jacket
skirt
2、复习学过的句型
What’s this ∕that in English?
What color is it?
3、注意名词的单复数 a pair of trousers/shorts/socks two pairs of trousers/shorts/socks Step2、练习、巩固新单词,完成活动1a、1b Step3、教授、练习新句型,完成活动1C
将dollar与人民币单位yuan相比较,注意dollar的单复数变化。
此环节中结合图片设计师生对话、结对活动、句子接龙等任务,让学生分小组竞赛,练习巩固新句型。在练习的过程中,将重点句型How much is it?发散为How much are they?重点掌握单复数在此句型中的变化。Step4.综合运用
How much is that red hat? It’s 6 dollars.How much are your white trousers?
They are 10 dollars.加大句子难度继续操练,巩固新词汇和句型。
此环节将表示颜色的形容词带入操练句型中,并结合学生穿的毛衣、裤子、身边的尺子、书包、铅笔、橡皮擦擦等物品让学生自己编对话。Step5、总结回顾 词汇:sock
T-shirt
shorts
sweater
trousers
shoe skirt
dollar
2、句型:--How much is this T-shirt?
--It’s 7 dollars.--How much are these socks?--they are 2 dollars.Homework: Ask about prices of your deskmate’s clothing, and write down your conversations.询问你同桌衣物的价格,并将你们的对话写下来。Step6、板书设计
Unit 4 How much are these socks?
(Section A
1a – 1c)Clothing
jacket
A: How much is this T-shirt? a pair of socks
B: It’s seven dollars.two pairs of trousers
A: How much are these socks? Shorts shoes skirt sweater
B: They are two dollars.
英语七年级上册课件(篇8)
我说课的内容是北师大版数学七年级上册第三章的第一节课《字母能表示什么》,我主要从“教材分析”、“教法与学法分析”、“教学过程设计与说明”、“设计追求的特色”四个方面组织说课。
本节课北师大出版的新课程标准实验教材第三章的第一节课,在以前的学习中学生比较熟悉对具体数的操作,这是学生初次接触用较为抽象的字母来表示数,对字母表示数含义的理解有助于代数式以及方程的列出,是学习后续知识的关键。
1.知识目标:在现实情景中感受用字母表示数的意义,明确字母可以表示任何数,会用字母表示探索的规律,能用字母表示运算律和公式。
2.能力目标:经历探索数量关系,发现规律,运用字母表示规律,并通过运算验证规律的过程。
3.情感目标:一是体会字母表示数的意义,形成初步的符号感;二是进一步感受数学魅力,在学习过程中激发学生学习数学、探索数学奥妙的内在动力和外在的积极性,并在过程中培养学生的创新意识和实践能力。
1.立足本人的分析确定的:字母表示数的意义、数学规律的探索及符号表达,这些内容也是本课的难点。
2.可能基于学生个性差异、基础差异在学习过程中感觉困难的地方也是本课的难点。在教学过程中,我将认真注意,并尽力帮学生突破。
我校是定点的移民子女、进城务工子女就读学校,留守生在班级中占38%,学生的个性、基础能力差异很大,加上七年级学生处于小学与初中的衔接过渡初期,所以本节课我选择引导探索与分层教学相结合的方法。在新知的引出过程中,注意由浅入深,由特殊到一般地提出问题。引导学生自主探索,尤其在形成新知生长点的时候,充分发挥分层教学法的优点,帮学有余力的发挥潜能,挖掘
潜能,在先行的基础上发挥他们“先学后教”(后教就是帮助老师教,当老师的助手,在过程中达到教学相长的功效),教师抽出精力帮助学习困难的学生,帮助有“怪问题”的学生。注重时间分配,尽量做到先学在当堂,同层竞赛在当堂,异层帮辅在当堂,练习探讨在当堂、激发兴趣在当堂。
在教学过程中,关注每一学生,让每一个学生都动起来,促成学生成为学习的主人,从而发挥学生的主体作用。
(一)情景导入:利用电子白板的幕布创设问题情境(插入背景音乐,增加形象性和趣味性):“一只青蛙1张嘴,2只眼睛4条腿,1声扑通跳下水。两只青蛙2张嘴,4只眼睛8条腿,2声扑通跳下水。三只青蛙3张嘴,6只眼睛12条腿,3声扑通跳下水。6767”,让学生把这首儿歌继续唱下去,唱几句即可,然后老师提问:在这首儿歌中假如有a只青蛙,那么请同学们思考一下,应该有多少张嘴,多少眼睛多少腿,以及多少声普通跳下水?问题设计具有一定的趣味性,引出可以用字母表示数。目的是激发学生的学习欲望,体现数学来源于实际生活,数学是从人的需要中产生这一认识的基本观点。
(二)实验操作:用电子白板拉出问题。鼓励学生用火柴棒或木棒,按照“口”、“日”、 “目”搭建正方形,然后填表,找规律。按照同层独立先竞争、异层小组后合作、全班交流分享的办法进行。
在处理问题的过程中,充分抓住新知的生长点做文章,前四个空是铺垫,后一个空是新知生长点。对学有余力的学生,要求把100变成10000填空。这样做既培养了独立思考、勇于探索的能力,又培养了学生的帮扶意识和合作品质,还激发了学生的进取精神。
(三)问题解决和方法交流:按照小组交流和班级分享的办法进行。展示出想到的各种方法,小组推荐代表发言,鼓励学生对发言进行诊断评价,及时提醒学生注意发言、评价有无不妥,充分发挥教师平等中的首席作用。在这个过程中,还注意数学学习氛围的打造,保持教师刻意打造学习氛围的意识。
(四)随堂练习。分层次推出练习。设置三组,一是必做题2个;二是挑战题2个;三是攻坚题4个。设计时注重了层次,必做体现了保底;挑战和攻坚有层次的观注了个性差异。在同层之间进行竞赛性的统计,控制了学生思考的松紧度。
随堂练习的评价由先行的学生负责,教师给予适当的提醒。基本按照学生先做----代表评价-----教师适当帮助的步骤进行。
(五)课堂小结:主要通过学生回忆本节课所学内容,从内容、应用、数学思想方法、获取新知的途径方面先进行小结。教师尽量不补尾巴。以免形成学生总结时注意力不集中,教师总结才听的局面,在学生总结不全面可以给足时间让学生补充,真正当好平等中的首席。
控制时间,尽量让学生当堂完成,不加重课后负担,不降低学习的积极性。
在本节课的设计过程中,我注重把握了以下几点:
1.既研究了教法,也研究了学法,基本按照以学定教的.思路进行设计。
2.重视了新知生长点,在新知生长点创造学生思考的问题,给足思考的空间。
3.注重了先学后教,而且尽可能让学有余力的学生去教,实现将带兵,兵促兵,兵教兵的局面。
4.发挥先进的教学手段如电子白板在教学中的辅助作用。
5.发挥学生的主体地位,摆正教师平等中的首席地位。
6.尽量做到课外不留作业,作业、练习分层安排,真正关注学生的个体差异。
7.注重创设学习氛围,激发兴趣,培养兴趣,巩固兴趣。
英语七年级上册课件(篇9)
教学内容:Unit 6 Do you like bananas?
教材解读
本单元主要讨论各种食物以及喜欢或不喜欢某种食物;询问某人是否喜欢某种食物及回答;会描述一日三餐,会合理搭配一日三餐。
like的一般现在时、一般疑问句及肯、否定回答;肯定句和否定句。
通过本单元的学习,认识到在平日饮食中要做到不挑食、不偏食、合理饮食。
教学目标
一、知识与技能
1.掌握基本词汇:food、banana、hamburger、tomato、broccoli、French fries、strawberry、orange、ice cream、salad。
2.掌握句型:Do you like bananas? Yes, I do./No, I don’t.二、过程与方法
通过听说读写等任务型活动,熟练应用所学单词和动词词组。
三、情感态度和价值观
认识并了解各种食物,能分清水果和蔬菜并能认识到水果和蔬菜对人体有益。通过询问对方是否喜欢某食物来引起话题。
教学重点
基本单词、词汇和句型。
教学难点
1.认识并掌握重点词汇。
2.能流利地与对方开展关于食物喜好的对话。教法导航
采用任务型教学途径并配以多媒体辅助教学,同时考虑学生的不同层次采取分层递进的教学方法。
学法导航
让学生在游戏的情景中感受到轻松愉悦、民主和谐的环境气氛,学生积极主动参与,从而产生了强烈的求知愿望,增强学习兴趣。
教学准备
PPT、关于食物的图片。教学过程
Step 1: Greetings.Greet the students as usual.Step 2: Revision Show the students pictures and ask:What’s this? It’s a soccer ball.Do you have a soccer ball? Yes, I do./No, I don’t.Do you like it? Yes, I do./No, I don’t.Step 3: New words Show the students some food and ask:
2What’s this? It’s a hamburger.Do you like it? Yes, I do./No, I don’t.What are these? They’re bananas.Do you like bananas? Yes, I do./No, I don’t.运用图片和对话教学单词:hamburger、banana、tomato、broccoli、French fries、strawberry、orange、ice cream、salad,并运用这些单词进行对话。
Step 4: Pair work Work in pairs and try to match the words with the pictures of 1a.Step 5: Listening 1b Listen and number the conversations.After listening, show the dialogue on the screen and get the students to practice the conversations, and then make their own conversations.Step 6: Listening Listen and circle the food you hear.First get the students to check their answers in groups and then report their answers.Step 7: Listen again Listen again and fill in the blanks.I like hamburgers.Do you like hamburgers? Yes, I do.Do you like______? No, I don’t like ______.Let’s have _______.Oh, no.I don’t like_________.Step 8: Group work Make a food survey in groups by asking: Do you like...? Then fill in the blanks to complete the form.How many students like hamburgers? How many students like bananas? Step 9: Summary Let’s sum what we have learned this class.Words:banana, hamburger, tomato, ice cream, salad, strawberry.Sentences:Do you like hamburgers? Yes, I do./No, I don’t.Step 10: Homework 1.Remember the words in this class.2.Practise the dialogue in pairs.课堂作业
1.写出下列名词
(1)汉堡 ____________(2)西红柿 _____________(3)沙拉 ____________(4)草莓 ____________(5)梨 ____________(6)牛奶 __________(7)面包 __________(8)冰激凌 _________2.根据句意完成句子
(1)A:_______ you like salad? B:No, I _______./Yes, I ______.(2)I __________(喜欢)hamburgers.(3)_____________(你喜欢)hamburgers?(4)____________(我们吃)strawberries.参考答案:
1.(1)hamburger(2)tomato(3)salad(4)strawberry(5)pear(6)milk(7)bread(8)ice cream
2.(1)Do, don’t, do(2)like(3)Do you like(4)Let’s教学反思
这节课以学生的日常生活为话题,用丰富多彩的实物和图片激发学生的学习兴趣,学生踊跃参加课堂活动,效果很好。
英语七年级上册课件(篇10)
Good morning ladies and gentlemen,
尊敬的各位评委老师上午好!
今天我要说课的内容是新目标七年级上册英语Unit8 when is your birthday? Section A部分。我将从以下几个方面阐述我的说课内容。
一、教材分析
1、Section A是本单元的重点部分,也是核心教学。为口语练习课,主要学习日期的表达。它上承Unit7的数字教学,下接Section B与以后有关日期的英语教学。因此本部分是前后知识的载体,在本单元以及今后的英语学习中都占重要的地位。
2、教学目标
《课程标准》中说:英语教学的目的是培养学生运用语言进行交际的能力,为用而学,在用中学,学了就用。因此我把本课的教学目标定为以下几个方面:
(1)、知识目标
①词汇掌握1-12月份,序数词1-31的表达
②日常交际用语when is your birthday?
My birthday is ….
③语法掌握日期表达法
(2)、能力目标
在连贯的听说读写活动中,训练学生的逻辑思维,快速反应能力和实践能力,使学生能熟练应用:when is your birthday?句型及其回答。
(3)、情感目标
热爱生命,孝敬父母的思想教育
3、本课的重点难点及其理论依据
根据《课程标准》,重点是掌握句型when is your birthday ?及其回答.
难点是日期表达中月份和序数词的正确使用。
二、教学策略
教学的实质是交际,为此我选用了以下教法:
1.提问引入法通过提问,由集体,分组,分行回答,或学生逐个回答的形式开展教学,检查和巩固新旧知识。
2.交际功能法通过集体,分组,两人,个人操练等形式,达到交际的目的。
三、学情分析
新制定的《英语课程标准》把“培养学生学习英语的兴趣,树立自信心,培养良好学习习惯和形成有效策略,发展自主学习和合作精神”放在了首位。依据新课改的精神,我从以下几个方面对学生进行学法指导。
⒈学习方法的指导
培养学生观察力,想象力,记忆力以及思维能力。用生动的课件调动学生的感观进行听说读写的训练。
⒉学习积极性的调动
我在教学过程中创造一种开放的,和谐的,积极互动的语言氛围,把课堂变成有声有色的舞台,让学生在乐中学。
⒊学习能力的培养
通过连贯的听说读写,游戏,竞赛等,培养学生的交际能力,发展他们的思维能力。
四、教学程序及设想
本课以交际为核心教学,我采用三步教学法,并且灵活穿插使用各步教学。
Step1 warming up(热身)
① Greeting体现师生之间的初步交际
②根据实际情况,用句型:what is your number?询问学生的学号,复习数字,激活旧知识,为学习新知识做铺垫。
③问学生:Are you happy today?告诉学生说:I am very happy today.Because today is my birthday.Would you like to sing a song for me?引导学生集体唱生日快乐歌。营造轻松活跃的课堂气氛,让学生带着积极活跃的心情进入课堂。
Step2 Presentation(呈现)
①利用歌曲的承上启下作用,说:Today is my birthday.When is your birthday?
How to say our birthday dates?从而引出月份的教学。
②利用多媒体手段,在一页页翻动的日历中学习1-12月的新单词。
③指着挂历上的日期说:My birthday is Oct.20th.加重语气重复20th,让学生初步感知序数词的读法。自然呈现序数词的教学。
④序数词教学过程中,让学生观察,归纳序数词的变化规律,培养学生的观察力,注意力和总结归纳能力。在教学中充分体现启发性教学原则。
⑤用卡片突出操练序数词中的几个特殊的数字,突破难点。
Step3. practise
① Ask and answer反复操练句型:when is your birthday? My birthday is ….通过集体练,小组练,两人练,个人轮流练习等方式,训练学生的语音,语调,提高语感。
②做相关练习1b和设计的练习,将听说读写有机结合,巩固新知识。
③布置作业:课后两个学生为一小组,就询问对方的生日编一段对话,第二天请学生上台表演。
五.板书设计:
January一月1st 2nd 3rd 4th 5th 6th
February二月7th 8th 9th 10th 11th 12th 13th 14th
March三月15th 16th 17th 18th 19th 20th 21st 22nd
April四月23rd 24th 25th 26th 27th 28th 29th 30th 31st
May五月
June六月
July七月When is your birthday?
August八月My birthday is October fourteenth.
September九月
October十月
November十一月
December十二月
英语七年级上册课件(篇11)
1、能听懂有关熟悉话题的语段和简短的故事,获取相关信息。
2、How to get somebody's telephone number? And what do we say?
3、能运用本单元的词汇和语言形式以及参照范例(文章结构)描述系列图片,编写简单的故事等,包括起草和修改。
4、利用情境等理解语法结构和表意功能,发现语言规律并举一反三。
5、了解语言的文化因素,体验跨文化交际。
6、根据句意及首字母补全单词。
7、熟悉掌握本节课的六个词汇。
8、总结你所知道的名和姓。
9、通过复习,培养学生根据卡片信息进行简单交流的能力。
10、利用预测、语调、重音、问题等来获取听力信息。
11、Isthisyourpencil?
12、了解并跨文化交际(恰当使用)。
13、利用读音规则和音标拼读词汇,利用上下文、非语言信息等理解词义,联想学习和记忆词汇,构词法等。
14、If youwant to show your politeness, what do you usually say when you first meetsomeone?
15、能运用…..词汇和…..语言形式以及参照范例(文章结构)写出简单的文段等,包括起草和修改。
16、What does the mid-autumn festival mean to Chinese?
17、How to ask and give telephone number?
18、能运用…..词汇和…..语言形式以及参照范例(文章结构)写出简单的文段等,包括起草和修改。
19、Howdoyouspellit?
英语七年级上册课件(篇12)
新目标英语七年级上册Unit5SectionA(1a-2c)教学设计
一、教材分析
1、教学内容
1)、词汇:do, have,tennis, ball,ping-pong ball, bat, soccer ball, volleyball, basketball, volleyball.2)、语言结构:A、Do you have a ping-pong ball?Yes,I do.Do you have a ping-pong bat?Not,I do not。Does she/he have a pen?Yes,she/he does
2、教材的地位及其作用
本单元的教学主要内容是:学习have的一般现在时的疑问式的肯定和否定回答,该话题与学生的日常生活紧密联系在一起,容易唤起学生的学习兴趣,这对于提高学生的综合能力很有帮助,特别是说的能力。
本单元仍在继续学习一般现在时,这是一个生活中离不开的时态,也是最基本的一个时态。新课程标准要求学生重点掌握一般现在时,这在英语中使用频率很高,学好这一时态的用法对以后其他时态的学习和交际有很大的帮助。
二、学生分析
学生现有的能力与已掌握的知识:
学生在已经学过词汇:What is this in English? What is that in English?It’s…
句型: Where is…? It’s in / on / under/…
经过前面的学习学生已经积累了一定的词汇,掌握了一定的目标语言,已经具备了一定的听说读写能力。
三、教学目标
1、语言知识
词汇:A、重点掌握表示有关各种运动球类的名词, 如basketball, soccer ball,so on
重点句型:? Do you/they have a TV? Yes,I/they do./No,I/they don’t.Does he/she have a soccer ball? Yes,he/she does./No,he/she doesn’t.2、语言技能
1)、能看着图片说;Do you/they have a TV? Yes,I/they do./No,I/they don’t.Does he/she have a soccer ball? Yes,he/she does./No,he/she doesn’t.3、学习策略、1)利用教材SectionA1a,2b所提供的图片卡片做出简单的判断。
2)通过与同学交流,学会使用一般现在时的疑问形式及肯定和否定回答。
4、情感态度、价值观
1)通过各小组的对话练习培养学生的合作精神;
2)通过学习本单元Section A,教会学生之间互相有无的主要句式.重点难点
1、Have 的一般现在时的疑问式用法;
2、Have的一般现在时的疑问句,及其肯定,否定回答;
3、简单拓展主语第三人称单数的句型。
教学手段:采用最简单的卡片图片、课本以及肢体语言。理念与思路、教法
1)采用图片进行直观教学。
2)学生在课堂教学过程中口头训练应成为本单元教学的重点内容。
教学突破:Section A重在通过使用动词have对物品的所属进行提问和回答的交流式口语活动,学习由助动词do或does引导的一般疑问句的构成以及回答。教师要善于引导学生比较行为动词的疑问句和be动词的疑问句在构成和回答上的区别,通过大量和反复地操练以达到运用自如。
四、教学过程
第一教学环节:情景创设,导入新课
教师活动 学生活动
Section A主要内容是通过使用have对物品的所属进行提问和应答,来学会使用do和does引导的一般疑问句。所以在教学中可采取问答式导人法:
掌握新单词.采用各种方法学习单词。
1、升降语调、拼读的方式记忆单词。2.检查学生记忆单词的成效。
3、学生看1a的图片,使字母和单词相对应。第二教学环节;老师和学生互动:学习掌握重要内容。
教师活动 学生活动(看图片练句型)
1.分片进行演示:I have a footba11.Do I have a football? 自己回答:Yes,I d0.再问:Do I have a basketball? 自己回答:No,I don’t.再使用其它物体和图片询问学生:Do I have…? 询问学生:Do you have…? 询问学生:…? 询问学生:Do they have…? 在学生充分掌握的第一,第二人称和第三人称 的复数。
2.学生回答:Yes,you do.No,you don’t.学生回答:Yes,I do.No,I don’t.学生回答:Yes,he/she does.No,he/she doesn’t.学生回答:Yes, they do.No,they don’t.掌握它的肯定和否定回答。
3、要求学生完成1b的听力,完成任务。
4.引导学生展开Pair work活动,完成l c部分口语交际的教学任务,学会运用助动词do进行问答,可采用师生互动带动学生互动的交流方式:
5.Pair work活动,完成l c部分口语交际的学习任务,学会运用助动词do进行问答并上台展示口语交际。
第三教学环节:合作交流,巩固提高
教师活动 学生活动
1、学生巩固练习活动,完成课堂练习和总结及笔头练习的教学任务。
2、让总结本课的 主要内容,如果不周到,教师可以补充完成。
3、习题练习,巩固课堂。问题探究与拓展活动
动词的第三人称单数形式:当句子的主语是“第三人称单数”时,即:不是I,不是you的其它单数形式时,谓语动词必须改变形式,也就是在词尾加-s或-es(同名词的复数形式),我们可以简称为“三单形式”。有些动词的变化是特殊的,如:have的三单形式是has。在构成否定句时。要在动词前加助动词don’t或doesn’t;在构成疑问句时,则要在主语前加上助动词do或does,does/doesn’t是do/don’t的第三人称单数形式。助动词后应该用动词的原型。
五、教学反思:
本单元重点学习的语法是do 和 does 引导的一般疑问句以及它们的回答方式,与此同时学习与运动有关的一些词汇。为此,在本单元我运用不同形式鼓励学生使用目标语言,在任务中体现学生的主体地位。在过程中学生可能出现一些不足,本人仍以积极的态度对待他们,逐渐地完善他们。愉快的氛围对学生的学习有很大的积极影响力。调动学生的学习兴趣和积极性至关重要,这方面,我正不断努力去做。
教无定法,教师不要为了任务活动而忽略了语言的传授。学生的信息交流要在特定的环境中进行,给他们参与的机会。任务的完成不是语言学习的结束,而是另一个高度的开端。加强学生语言的实践训练是改革的关键,要给学生机会去说、去做、去思考。
仁爱英语七年级上册课件四篇
请看下面幼儿教师教育网小编为您收集的“仁爱英语七年级上册课件”相关信息。做好教案课件是老师上好课的前提,因此在写的时候就不要草草了事了。 学生反应可以反映教师对课程安排的条理性和合理性。请注意以下内容仅供参考!
仁爱英语七年级上册课件 篇1
本节是单元第一课时,通过观察多张照片,对其中人物所做事情的讨论,锻炼学生的观察能力及表达能力,通过进一步的游戏环节,拓展新的学习内容,体现了英语教育的趣味性和实用性。
1.掌握现在进行时的运用和表达的意思,关注人称和动词的搭配。
2.句型What are you doing?I’m doing sth..
What is he/she doing?He/she is doing sth..
Is he/she doing sth.?Yes,he/she is.或No,he/she isn’t.
3.掌握肯定句和一般疑问句的句型转换及其回答。
1.培养学生学以致用的能力,养成良好的`观察能力。
2.培养学生主动参与学习,善于与他人合作学习的能力。
培养学生热爱学习,热爱劳动,热爱生活,珍惜生命的积极的人生观。
教学重点:What are you doing?I’m doing sth..
What is he/she doing?He/she is doing sth..
Is he/she doing sth.?Yes,he/she is.或No,he/she isn’t.
教学难点:用be doing来表示说话的瞬间正在做某事。
采用让学生动手操作、合作探究、媒体演示的教学方法来突出重点、突破难点。
本节课主要是对于正在发生的事情进行讨论,先利用欣赏电影片段吸引学生的注意力,教育学生要热爱生活,再利用观看照片来讨论某一瞬间发生的事情。并在课堂教学中将尽量为学生提供参与活动的场景,用任务型教学法让学生进行小组学习,抓住英语交际的机会,感知体验,大胆实践,使学生自得知识、自寻方法、自觅规律、自悟道理。
1.Greeting :
Teacher: Hello, everyone. How are you? Today is a nice day, isn’t it?So what do you want to do? And why?点一个举手的学生回答,再面向全班: I like watching TV at home. Because it’s relaxing. Do you want to watch TV?得到肯定回答后,T:Now let’s go to watch TV.进入幻3,点击右下角的铃铛播放电影《泰坦尼克》结尾片段。看完后,T:Do you know its name? Do you like it? Why?学生回答后,老师显示字幕:Don’t let go. Love your life.
设计目的:通过观看著名的电影片段来吸引学生的注意力,向学生灌输热爱生活珍惜生命的情感教育。
1、T:I have some photos.展示幻4的照片:Look! This is my life.I’mdoing some things at home.用红外线灯照射每张照片,学生可以通过照片明白句子的意思。老师指着每张照片带读句子(同时做出相应的动作):I’m watching TV/cleaning/reading/talking on the phone/playing computer games/teaching.认读完最后一张自己上课的照片后,T: what’s my job? ... yes,I’m a teacher.
然后老师设计打电话的场景:hello, thisisMiss Liu. Today is a nice day. I’m watching TV at home. What about you?进行师生间的对话,起示范作用,让学生能仿造使用幻灯片上的句子回答,并对能使用其他动作回答的同学予以奖励。每个be doing形式都用红色标注,提示学生注意。
设计目的:通过展示老师自己的照片吸引学生的注意,输出新知识,用带读和创设情境的对话形式,让学生初步理解并能表达自己正在做某事。
展示幻5,T:now,let’s look at other photos. Who is in these photos?老师问几个举手的学生:what are you doing?然后让学生仿照进行pairwork活动:Can you ask your friend ‘what are you doing’?并请几组进行演示,每组演示之后,老师问大家:what is…doing?借机转换人称。
设计目的:创情设景,用学生自己的schoollife照片让大家有话可说,并可借机转换人称,转入下一环节。
展示幻6,T:now,we are in a happy apartment. These people are doing some things. Let’s listen to the conversation. Then tell me: What are these people doing?听完录音后,T ask S1:what is Jenny doing? S1: she is watching TV.T点击屏幕检验。T转向S2:Can you ask your friend about Dave and Mary?然后用以上问句依次请几组同学对图中人物内容进行问答。
设计目的:充分挖掘听力材料,利用其锻炼学生们的听说能力,并成功实现转换人称的问答,使学生能了解并掌握如何询问其他人正在做什么及其回答。
展示幻7,T:now,let’s make a survey in your group. What are your friends doing now? I’ll give you 3 minutes. You can ask 4 friends, and write down on the chart, then make a report.3分钟之后,T: Can you make a report?请每组派一代表汇报,并进行奖励,T可以插入问句:what is … doing ?。
设计目的:通过小组活动培养学生的合作学习能力和认真聆听他人的良好习惯。
1、展示幻8,T:Look! Tom is doing something. Do you know, what is Tom doing?Oh, let me guess. Is Tom writing? S: No, he isn’t. T继续猜,直到S说Yes, he is.为止。点击可检验答案。再点击出现下一个人物。重复以上老师猜,学生答的活动。
设计目的:因为此片内容是书上有的,学生知道谜底,所以由老师做示范来猜,学生回答,锻炼学生认真听的习惯。
2、展示幻9,T:Now, It’our fun time. Do you know this cat? What’s his name? S: ... T: yes, he’s Tom.Now,Let’s talk about these pictures. You can ask your friends in your group,what is Tom doing?3 students as a group. And One ask, the others answer .每组发一份图片进行组内讨论。份图片进行组内讨论。3分钟后请几组学生演示,T:You can ask 2 questions.3人一组,一人用红灯照射图片问,另两人答,奖励表现良好的小组。
设计目的:在重温对话what is he doing?的同时,了解各图的内容,为下一环节做铺垫。
3、点击出现幻10和问句Is Tom sleeping?T: Now, What is Tom doing? Is Tom sleeping? (T做睡觉的动作)全班看着图片齐答:Yes, he is.或No, he isn’t.
T:Who wants to guess the next picture?请一个学生上台来背对屏幕玩猜谜游戏:示意全班问他:What is Tom doing?此学生边做动作边猜测:Is Tom drinking?全班齐答Yes,he is.或No,he isn’t.猜到者有奖。
设计目的:在游戏中学,在快乐中锻炼听说能力,避免了枯燥的教与学。
请一个学生对于此课所学进行总结,老师给予及时的评论,并点击进入幻11展示语法小结:现在进行时态。
设计目的:初一的内容是基础教学,语法在最后有必要呈现出来,让大家知道所学内容的专业术语。让学生自己总结更能加深印象。
仁爱英语七年级上册课件 篇2
新版人教版七年级上册英语课件
定语从句:
(一)基础:引导词---who, which, that, whom,
练习1.I like cities___________are quiet and clean. 2.I prefer students _________are hard- working.
3.I hate TV shows _________ are noisy and boring.4.The music __________ is gentle and quiet attracts me a lot.
5.The food __________tastes delicious is not always healthy.
6.Those boys ___________ are playing basketballs over there are from Class Fifteen.
7.The books ____________ are written by Lu Xun are worth reading.
8.The town ___we visited last week is much larger than before.9.The book ___ he bought is very interesting.
(二)特例:只用that的情况
1先行词被___________或___________所修饰,或本身是______________________时,只能用 that,
2.被修饰的先行词为 ________________________________________________等不定代词时, 只能用 that.
3.先行词被 _____________________________________________等词修饰时,只能用 that,而不用 which。
4.先行词里同时含有______________________,如I can remember well the persons and some pictures that I saw in the room.
5. 以______________________引导的特殊疑问句,只能用that.如: Who is the girl that is crying?
练习1. I am interested in everything___ is about the World Cup.
2. Is there anything___I can do for you? 3. This is the very bike ______I lost
4.To my surprise, he gave me nothing __ I need. 5.This is the best dictionary __ I have ever used.
6. He was the first person _______passed the exam.
7.He talked happily about the men and books________interested him greatly.
(三)whose 1. The student ______father works in the factory is sitting there.
2. I like the rooms ______windows face south.3. This is the desk ______legs were broken.
4The woman ___ umbrella you took is angry about it.5.Here comes a girl ___ handwriting is the best .
6The banana __skin is green can’t be eaten.7That tall tree _ leaves are yellow is very old.
(四)从句谓语单复数由先行词确定,时态由从句时间状语决定,不必跟主句保持一致。
1-He is one of the boys who ____ (doesn’t, don’t) finish doing homework.
2-I like films which ____(be) exciting and interesting.
3-Children who often ____(eat) junk food are easy to become fat and unhealthy.
4-That boy who _____(run) fastest is from our class.
5Those boys who ____ playing the guitar are from our school. (be)
6The trees which _____ (be) watered yesterday belong to them. 7The man who ____ over there is our teacher.(stand) 8Those boys who ____ playing the guitar are from our school. (be)
9Mr. Brown is one of the foreign experts _______ _________ (work) in China.
10I’m one of the boys ______ ________(like) English best.
(五)“介词+关系代词”注意: 介词的选用要考虑:
A.与先行词的搭配关系
1)I will never forget the day __________ I joined the army.
2) I will never forget the days ______ I worked here.
3) I will never forget the year ____________ my son went to college.
B. 与谓语动词的搭配习惯
1)Have you found the book ________I paid 29 dollars?
2)Have you found the book ________I spent 29 dollars?
3) Have you found the book _____________we learnt a lot?
4) Have you found the book _______she often talks?
关系副词的用法
练习:1. It must be a good place ________________we can do a lot of exercise.
2.This is the village _________________we visited last week.
3.The house _______ we live in is very big./ The house _______ we live is very big
4. The woman ___________ talked to you just now is a doctor. The woman ______ you talked to is my sister.
The woman to ___________ you talked is my sister. 5. This is the hospital ____________ I was born in.
This is the hospital in _________I was born. This is the hospital____________ I was born.
综合练习一. 用适当的关系代词或关系副词填空
1. The boy ______ is wearing the black jacket is very clever.
2. This is the present ____he gave me for my birthday.3.The man _______ talked to you just now is an engineer.
4. He talked about the teachers and schools _______ he had visited.
5. There is nothing in the world ______can frighten him.6. We visited a factory _______makes toys for children.
7. Is this the place _______ your father once lived 8. I’ll never forget the days _______ I joined the League.
9The car______my father bought last month is beautiful.10The man______hair is white is his grandfather.
二 ( )1.Rosa likes music ___ is quiet and gentle. A. when B. that C. where D. who
( )2.--Is the girl _ is interviewing the manager of that company your friend--Yes, she is a journalist from CCTV.
A. whom B. which C. who D. whose
( )3 Yao Ming is a famous basketball star ___ is playing in the NBA. A. whose B. who C. what D. which
( )4. The doctor ___I am waiting for is Mr. Smith. A. which B. whom C. whose D. why
( )5. --- Do you know Hong Zhanhui? ---Yes. He’s the college student ____ has moved Chinese people a lot.
A. who B. which C. what D. whom
( )6. In my family, my sister is the only person __ loves chocolate. A. which B. who C. whom D. she
( )7. This is the place ____ the old man lived last year. A. when B. where C. that D.which
( ) 8. The song ___ Jay Zhou sings are popular with students. A. why B. whom C. what D. which
( )9. The farmer was very thankful to the doctor ___ treated his son. A. what B. which C. who D. whose
( )10.I like to live in a house__ is big and bright. A. that B. who C. how D. why
( )11. The young lady ___ we met yesterday is our new math teacher. A. what B. whose C. whom D. which
( )12. --Can you introduce the town to me? --OK. This is the town in __ I was born. A. that B. who C. which
( )13. Miss green is the only person __ can help you with your English. A. she B. whom C. which D. who
( )14. I like the second football match ___was held last week. A. which B. who C. that D. /
( )15. Is there anything ____ to you? A. that is belonged B. that belongs C. that belong D. which belongs
( )16. I hate people ___ don’t help others when they are in trouble. A. who B. which C. they
( )17. This is the only book ___I am looking for. A. that B. which C. who D. whom
( )18 Her sister__ you met at my home was a teacher of English. A. whom B. that is C. which D. who is
( )19 The book__is sold out at the moment. A.you need Bwhat you need C.which you need it D that you need it
( )20 I'm one of the boys ______never late for school. A. that is B. who are C. who am D. who is
( )21.__cleans the classroom can go home first. A. Anyone B. Those who C. However D. The one who
( )22. The old man __yesterday is a scientist.A.I spoke B. I spoke to C. whom I spoke D. that I spoke to him
中考定语从句真题演练
1.--- Is the girl __ is interviewing the manager of that company your friend? --Yes, she is a journalist from CCTV. A. whom B. which C. who D. whose
2. Do you still remember the movie _____ we saw last weekend? A. who B. what C. that D. whom
3. ---Who is your new English teacher? ---Elena, the woman ____ is wearing a red T-shirt over there.
A. 不填 B. whom C. whose D. who
4. Is that the man _____ helped us a lot after the earthquake? A. whose B. which C. when D. who
5. ---What are you looking for? --- I’m looking for the pen ___ I bought yesterday. A. who B. which C. whose
6. This is the novel_____ written by Guo Jingming. A. who B. what C. that D. /
7. We should be ready to help the people ____ are in trouble. A. whose B. whom C. which D. who
8. Two years has passed, but Chinese people still remember those exciting days ____ they spent during the Beijing Olympic Games. A. that B. who C. when
9. The magician _____ played magic tricks in 2008 CCTV Spring Festival Gala is Liu Qian. He is popular in China now. A. whose B. who C. which
10. July likes music very much. She likes music ____ she can dance to. A. what B. who C. that
11. At school, you should do the things _____ are allowed by the teachers. A. that B. when C. what
12. Thought is the key _____ opens the doors of the world. A. why B. where C. which D. who
13. The gentlemen ___ are coming to my office tomorrow are my classmates many years ago.
A. whom B. who C. those D. which
14. That’s the man _____ house was destroyed in the storm. A. that B. whose C. who D. which
15. The girl ____ I just talked with is Ben’s sister. A. whom B. which C. she
16. I love people ____ are friendly to others. A. which B. whose C. what D. who
17. It’s time to say goodbye to my school. I’ll always remember the people _____ have helped me.
A. who B. what C. which D. where
18. I like the teacher ____ classes are very interesting and creative. A. which B. who C. what D. whose
19. Do you know the boy ____ is sitting next to Peter? ---Yes. He is Peter’s friend. They are celebrating his ____ birthday. A. who, ninth B. that, nineth C. /, nineth D. which, ninth
20.ShaolinTemple__lies in the west of Zhengzhou welcomes the visitors from abroad.A.where B.which C.who
二宾语从句
1宾语从句的学习要注意三个方面
第一:语序:在宾语从句中,一律用___________。
如Where does she live? ( Do you know?) ----Do you know where she lives?
***几个特殊的特殊疑问句
Which is the way to the nearest shop?/ What’s wrong with you?/ What’s up?/ What’s the matter?
这几个特殊疑问句本身就是陈述语序,在宾语从句中不需调整语序。
第二:时态; 1)如果主句是___________,宾语从句时态根据实际情况而定.
如:1. It’s going to rain. I think. ---I think it’s going to rain.
2. “I will go with you .” he says. ---He says he will go with me.
3. He studied English ten years ago. I know. I know he studied English ten years ago.
2)主句是___________,宾语从句要用___________。
如:It’s going to rain. I thought. ---I thought it was going to rain.
“I will go with you.” he said. ---He said he would go with me.
3). 若从句表达的是___________,规律,不管主句是什么时态,从句都用___________。
如1 The earth turns round the sun. The teacher told us---The teacher told us that the earth turns round the sun.
2 Light travels much faster than sound. She said … ---She said that light travels much faster than sound.
第三:连接词1)如果被连接的句子是___________,那么连接词用___________, (也可省)
如1. He’ll be back in a month. ( I hear…) I hear ( that ) he will be back in a month.
2. I have been to the Great Wall once. ( He tells me…) He tells me ( that ) he has been to the Great Wall once.
2.)如果被连接的句子是___________,则用连接词___________
如:*Does he live in that house? ( She asked me …) She asked me if/ whether he lived in that house.
*Have you finished your homework? ( I want to know…) I want to know if you have finished your homework.
3) ___________句,用原句中的特殊疑问词引导:what, who, where, when, which, why, how (many/ much/ often/ long/ old).如: Who are you waiting for? Can you tell me? --- Can you tell me who you are waiting for?
What did he do yesterday? I don’t know. ---I don’t know what he did yesterday.
***其中 以wh- 疑问词或how 引导的宾语从句与动词不定式可相互转换
如I don’t know what I can do.可以说成 I don’t know what to do.
The policeman showed me where I could get books. 可以说成The policeman showed me where to get books.
Can you tell me how I can make a kite?可以说成 Can you tell me how to make a kite?
4).宾语从句___________。在_________________________________等动词所跟的`宾语中,如果从句谓语是否定的,一般要将否定词not转移至主句谓语上去,而将从句谓语改为肯定形式。如:I don’t think he has time to play with the girl.
二.综合练习
1.I want to know __
A. whom is she looking after B. whom she is looking C.whom is she looking D.whom she is looking after
2.I don't know _________ the day after tomorrow.
A.when does he come B.how will he come C.if he comes D.whether he'll come
3.Could you tell me _________ the nearest hospital is?A.what B.how C.whether D.where
4.Could you tell me _________ the radio without any help?
A.how did he mend B.what did he mend C.how he mended D.what he mended
5.I don't know if he____ tomorrow. If he _____,I'll tell you.
A.comes, comes B.will come, will come C. will come, comes D. comes, will come
6.Do you know where _________ now?A.he lives B.does he live C.he lived D.did he live
7.Do you know what time ___?A.the train leave B.does the train leave C.will the train leave Dthe train leaves
8.I don't know _________ .Can you tell me,please? A.how the two players are old
B.how old are the two players C.the two players are how old D.how old the two players are
9.The small children don't know _________ . A.what is their stockings in
B.what is in their stockings C.where is their stockings in D.what in their stockings
10.I can't understand _________ . A.what does Christmas mean B.what Christmas does mean
C.what mean Christmas does D.what Christmas means
11 . When the job______, let me know. A .do B .done C .is done D .finished
12 .She asked me if I knew__ .A .whose pen is it B .whose pen it was C whose pen it is D .whose pen was it 13 .Miss Li wants to know _____________next week . A .when my uncle leaves
B .when will my uncle leave C .where my uncle will stay D .where does my uncle stay
14 .Could you tell me ________________with the money ? A .how to do B .what should I do C .how I should do D .what I should do
中考宾语从句真题演练
( )1. Everyone can play an important role in the society.As members,we should try our best to do__.
A. what we should do B. what should we do C. how we should do
( )2. --I really hope to keep in touch with Lily. --Sorry. I don't know __.
A. what her name is B. what her job is C. what her number is D. when she left
( )3 —Can you tell me ______? —By doing more speaking. A how I will improve my English
B. which way can I choose C. how do I deal with my English D. what’s wrong with my English
( )4. How lovely the dog is ! Can you tell me _____?
A. where did you get it B. where will you get it C. where you got it
( )5.. --Excuse me, could you tell me ____ the book about aliens? --Sure, take the escalator to the second floor.
A. where I can buy B. where can I buy C. when can I buy D. when I can buy
( )6-“Do you know_ have our summer holiday?”-“Next week.”A.when will we B.when are weC. when we will
( )7 ---Do you know ____ the MP4 yesterday? -- Sorry, I’ve no idea about it.
A. how much did he pay for B. how much he paid for C. he paid for how much D. he paid how much for
( )8--What time will Mr. Brown be back to China? -- Sorry. I don’t know ___.
A. when did he go abroad B.why he is going abroad C.how soon will he be back Dhow long he will stay abroad
( )9. You can’t image ___ when the pupils received these nice presents on Children’s Day.
A. how they were excited B. how excited they were C. how excited were they D. they were how excited
( )10. –Can you tell me ______?–She is in the computer lab.
A. where Linda was B. where is Linda C. where was Linda D. where Linda
( )11. –Do you know _______ the Capital Museum? –Next Friday.
A. when will they visit B. when they will visit C. when did they visit D. when they visited
( )12. He wanted to know____the English party.
A. when will we have B. when we will have C. when would we have D. when we would have
( )13. I want to know_______.
A. when we should arrive at the airport B. when should we arrive at the airport
C. when the airport we should arrive at D. when the airport should we arrive at
( )14. –David, look at the man in white over there. Can you tell me_______? –He is a doctor.
A. who is he B. who he is C. what is he D. what he is
( )15. –Do you know___the girl in red is? –I’m not sure. Maybe a teacher. A. when B. how C. where D. what
( )16. Your T-shirt is so cool. Could you tell me ________?
A. where you buy it B. where do you buy it C. where you bought it D. where did you buy it is
( )17. I really want to know ____ . A. what is wrong with my brother
B. how will he go to Beijing tomorrow C. if had he bought that car D. where did he go yesterday
( )18. Excuse me, sir. Could you tell me ?
A.where is the bank nearestB. where is the nearest bankC.where the nearest bank isD. the nearest bank is where
( )19.Lily’s mother looked for her for half an hour, but couldn’t find ____.
A. What Lily was. B. What was Lily C. Where Lily was D. Where was Lily
( )20--Could you tell me___? He is wanted by the head teacher.--Sorry, I’ve no idea.But he _ here just now.
A. where Tim was, was B. where is Tim,was C. where Tim is,was D.where Tim is,is
三、状语从句:
一).条件状语从句:引导词为:if, unless。
形式:
主句_______________, 从句______________.
练习:1.I am waiting for my friend.____________, I’ll do shopping alone.
A.If she comes B.If she will come C.If she doesn’t come D.If she didn’t come
2.I am sure I can make it better, if our teacher _________me a second chance.A.give B.gave C.gives D.will give
3.The art club is for members only. You can’t go in___you are a member. A.unless B.Because C.if D.though
4.I ________the CDs to you if I have time tomorrow. A.will return B.returned C.have returned D.return
5. 1)You won’t pass the final exam ___________(除非)you work hard.
2) The children __________ climb the mountain if it __________________(不下雨)
3) _______________________if he comes. (给我打电话)
二)时间状语从句:(常见从属连词有when,before, after, until, as soon as, while…)
1)As soon as he _____in Paris, he will call you. A.arrive B.arrived C.arrives
2)Don’t leave until the rain_______.A.stopped B.stops C.stopping D.stop
3)You can go skating after you ____A.finish the job B.finished the job C.finishing the job
4) I’ll tell her the good news when he _____ back. A.came es e
5)Father was watching TV ________ Mum was washing dishes. A.before B. while C.after D.until
6)I was watching TV ____ you called me last night. A.when B.while C.until D.after
7) I ______ here since I came to China. d B.have lived C.am living D. had living
8).My grandma didn’t go to sleep______ I got back home. A.till B.until C.since D.when
三)原因状语从句: (常用连词有because, since, as)
1. Tom is ill at home, _____he can’t come here. A.so B.if C.because D.and
2.—Why did you come to school late this morning?--___I watched the Football World Cup until 12:00 last night. A.If B.Because C.Since D.Though
3.I hope to go to France some day__there are many museums there.A.though B. unless C. because D. where
四)结果状语从句:由so… that…/such…that/so that引导的从句(so后接形、副原级)
1)与too…to…句型的转换:
He ran so fast that I couldn’t catch up with him. =______________________________________________
The box is so heavy that I can’t carry it= ___________________________________________________
2)“so… that +从句”与“enough to”的替换
He’s so strong that he can carry the box.=___________________________________________________
He is not old enough to go to school.=________________________________________________________
3)so that…/ so…that…/such…that ____________________________________________________________
如:He got up early in the morning so that he could catch the early bus.
The boy is so strong that he can lift up the heavy stone. He is such a clever boy that all of us like him.
练习:1.--He was _______tired ______he fell asleep as soon as he lay down. -- Oh, we can go out and let him have a good rest..A.too;to B.so; that C.enough; to D.such; that
2.There were _______many people ____I couldn’t find where she is. A.so;that B.so;as C.such;that D.as;that
3. He ran as fast as possible__he could reach school on time. A.in order to B so as to C such that D so that
4. They are ___interesting books __ I want to read them once more.A.so that B.such…that C.too…to D.so…that
综合练习
1.You may leave the classroom when you__writing.A.will finish Bare finishing C have finished Dhad finished
2. Would you give Johnny this letter if you ________ to see him this week.
A. will happen B. happen C. are happened D. happened
3. She was busy, ____she couldn’t go to your birthday party last night. A. and B. so C. or D. but
4. English is ________ a useful language ________ it is spoken in many countries of the world.
A. so…that B. such…that C. so…because D. such…because
5. Don’t cross the street __ the traffic lights are green. A. after B. until C. while D. since
6. Your dream won’t come true__ you know what your dream is. A. after B. unless C. while D. since
7. --Could you ask him if he __to my birthday party next Sunday? –I will, if I __ him this afternoon.
A. comes, meet B. will come, will meet C. comes, will meet D. will come, meet
8. Sarah is ______ a hard-working girl ______ she often works late into night.
A. so; that B. too; to C. such; that D. not only; but also
状语从句真题练习
1.—Where was your brother at this time last night?—He was writing an e-mail ___I was watching TV at home.
A.as soon as B.after C.until D.while
2.The film “Kung Fu Panda” is___interesting__I would like to see it again. A.such,that B.too,to C.as,as D.so that
3.Tom will call me as soon as he ___home. A.gets B.has got C.got D.will get
4. We will have no water to drink___we don’t protect the earth. A.until B.before C.though D.if
5.We won’t start the meeting ___our teacher arrives. A.though B.until C.while D.or
6.Bob promises to join in the football match____he has to help his parents on the farm..
A. if B.as C. unless D. when
7.___it’s difficult to make her dream come ture, she never gives up. A.Though B.Unless C.Because D.If
8.---Could you tell me when Mr. Li___in Huanggang?---Sure. When he ___, I’ll call you.
A.arrives; will arrive B.will arrive; arrives C.arrives; arrives D.will arrive; will arrive
9.In summer, food goes bad easily__it is put in the refrigerator. A.until B.if C.unless
10.A moment, please. I’m checking if Mr. Smith__free tomorrow. A.is B.being C.to be D.will be
11.I didn’t go to bed __my mother came back late last night.A.so; B.until C.though
12.Hurry up,___you will miss the early train. A. or B.and C.if D.unless
13.---Tommy, do you know if Frank___to the theatre with us this Sunday if it ___?---Sorry, I have no idea.
A.will go, is fine; B.goes, is fine C.will go, is going to be fine D.goes; will be fine
14.What a beautiful painting it is! I’ve never seen ___painting. A.such a B.a C.such D.this better
15.I don’t know __he will come tomorrow.___he comes, I’ll tell you.
A.if, Whether B.whether, Whether C.if, That D.if, If
复合句综合检测
( )1.Is this museum_ they visited last month? A. that B. where C. which D. the one
( )2. Is that book ____ he borrowed on Friday? A. that B. which C. who D. the one
( )3 The second book__I want to read is Business at the Speed of Thought. A. which B. what C. that D. as
( )4 –Do you know the man __is running along the street? A who B which C whom
( )5. Without friendship, one can’t be happy although he is rich enough. As for me, I will never forget the days ___I spent with my dearest friend. A that B when C who
( )6 This is the best TV play __we have seen this year. A when B what C who D that
( )7--Have you found the information about famous people ____you can use for report?
--Not yet. I’ll search some on the Internet. A which B who C what D whom
( )8--Have you been to the Sports Center___ is just opened in town? - -No, no yet.
A where B who C that D when
( )9 --Bob, where do you work?--I work for a company ___sells cars. A which B where C what
( )10____ have finished the work can leave. A. Those who B. Anyone C. The one who
( )11. The building that ___new is our school. A. is B. are C. was D. were
( )12. The pandas that we saved ____better now. A. are B. were C. is D. was
( )13 This is the only thing _________ I have lost.A.which B.that C.where
( )14.--Could you tell me____?--Sorry, I don’t know. I was not at the meeting. A. what does he say at the meeting. B what did he say at the meeting. C. what he says at the meeting D. what he said at the meeting
( )15. No one can be sure____ in a million years.
A. what man looks like B. what will man look like C. man will look like what D. what man will look like
( )16. -- Could you tell me ____?-- She is a student in Eton School.
A. where Kate is studying B. how Kate studies C .why Kate was studying D. when Kate studied
( )17.-- Could you tell me___ yesterday?-- About two hours. A. How long it takes to fly to Guilin B. How long it took to fly to Guilin C.How long does it take to fly to Guiln D. How long did it take to fly to Guilin
( )18. Please tell me____.A. what is wrong with the boy B. what is the boy wrong C. what wrong the boy is
( )19. She will hate him when she _more about him .A.knowsB .know C.will know Dis going to know
( )20. --Excuse me. Do you know_____?--Sorry, I don’t know. A. where is No. 1 Middle School
B. where No. 1 Middle School is C. No. 1 Middle School is where D. No. 1 Middle School where is
( )21. At the science museum,the boys and girls get to know__________. A. what is the spaceship like
B. what the spaceship looks like C. how the spaceship looks 1ike D. how does the spaceship1ook like
( )22. He didn’t tell me ____.
A. which floor did he live on B. which floor he lived on C. which floor he lived D. he lived on which floor
( )23. I’m new here. Could you tell me__, please?A. when does the first bus arrive B. when the first bus arrives
C. when did the first bus arrive D.when will the first bus arrive
( )24. I wonder how long_______school?
A. has he been away from B. he has been away C. he has left D. he has been away from
( )25. ---We can use MSN to talk with each other on the Internet. ---Really? Will you please show ____it? ‘
A. what to use B. how to use C. how can I use D. where can I use
( )26. The teacher asked the students . A. if they were interested in chatting online
B. when was Albert Einstein born C. what they will do with the computers D. how often they go to movies
( )27---Could you tell me how long __the book?--Three days.
A.I can keep B.can I borrow C.I can borrow D. can I keep
( )28.I can’t understand ___the boy alone at home.
A.why she left B.did she leave C.why had she left D.why she leave
( )29. You will not succeeded if you ______ harder. A. will work B. won’t work C. work D. don’t work
( )30.Write clearly __your teacher can understand you correctly. A.since B.for C.because Dso that
( )31.______he failed , he went on doing the experiment .A. Even B. Yet C. Although D. in spite of
( )32.The dog went out while we __ supper. A. had B. had had C. were having D. would have
( )33.His brother has worked there ________ he left schoo A.when B. after C. since D. until
( )34.The boy didn’t stop talking ____the second bell rang. A.when B. until C. after D. because
( )35. __I came into the office, the teacher were having a meeting.A.While B. When C. Once D. Since
( )36.I was about to leave my house __ the telephone rang. A.while B. as C. when D. since
七年级上册英语人教版篇一:人教版英语+七年级上册各单元知识点详解
StarterUnit1Goodmorning.
1.Goodmorning/afternoon/evening早上(上午)/下午/晚上好。答语相同。在熟人或家人之间可省略good.熟人之间的问候可加上称呼语,称呼语放在问候语之后且用逗号隔开。如:Goodmorning,class!同学们,早上好!△Goodnight!晚安(晚间告别用语)2.Hello,Frank!你好,弗兰克。
3.A;Ho上午pm下午cm厘米mm毫米11.英语句子的书写
句子开头的第一个单词的第一个字母要大写,单词与单词之间要有适当的距离,一般为放入一个字母的空隙,句末要有标点符号,英语的句号是个实心圆点,而不是汉语中的小圆圈。12.大写字母的用法
1)英语句子开头的第一个字母必须大写。
2)I(我),OK在句中任何位置都大写。
3)人名、地名、国名、某国人或某种语言等专有名词的第一个字母必须大写。
4)电影名、书名、报刊、文章的标题等中的每个实词(如:名词、动词、形容词、副词、数词)的第一个字母一般大写。EnglishWeekly《英语周报》Titanic《泰坦尼克号》5)表示月份、星期、重要节日的名词的第一个字母必须大写。6)某些缩略词的第一个字母都必须大写。
7)表示称呼的名词的第一个字母通常要大写。UncleWang王叔叔
14.英语句子成分
一、主语(subject):句子说明的人或事物。
1.Thesunrisesintheeast.太阳从东方升起。(名词)2.Helikesdancing.他喜欢跳舞。(代词)
3.Tovie去看电影
2、助动词do/does的用法。
3、Whatkind(of)用来问种类:Whatkind(ofmovie)doyoulike?
4、too,ase你的名字firstname名字lastname姓氏hername她的名字
telephone/phonenumber电话号码inChina在中国
2.必背典句:
1.—nicetomeetyou!见到你很高兴!
—Nicetomeetyou,too.见到你我也很高兴。
2.—What’syourname?你的名字是什么?
—Alan.艾伦
3.I’mJenny我是珍妮。
4.What’shis/hername?他的/她的名字是什么?
5.Hername’sMary.她的名字是玛丽。
6.What’syourfirst/lastname?你的名字/姓氏是什么?
7.—What’shistelephonenumber?他的电话号码是多少?
—It’s876-9548是876-9548.
3.形容词性物主代词
物主代词是表示所有关系的代词,是人称代词的属格形式。它分第一人称、第二人称和第三
人称,每个人称又分单数和复数。物主代词分形容词性物主代词和名词性物主代词。
形容词性物主代词的用法和形容词的用法相似,具有形容词的性质。在句中作定语,(于:eC.myD.mine
(河北)Georgereadsthenewspapereverymorning.That’shabit.
A.heB.himC.hisD.himself
(四川南充中考)SheisastudentandnameisKate.
A.sheB.herC.hers
4.be动词用法
(1)be动词(am,is,are)这三个动词常用做连系动词,在句子中起连接主语和表语的作用。
Thisismymother.这是我的妈妈。
Iamnine.我九岁了。
Youaremygoodfriend.你是我的好朋友。
(2)be动词三种形式的使用主要取决于主语。主语是第一人称I(我)时,用am,主语是第二
人称you(你,你们)或名词及代词的复数时,用are,主语是第三人称单数it/he/she(它/
他/她)或名词及代词单数时,用is.
(3)am,is,are的意思是“是”,但不能处处翻译成“是”。例,Howareyou?你好吗?
5.What引导的特殊疑问句
英语中用于提出疑问的句子叫疑问句,以what等特殊疑问词开头的句子叫特殊疑问句,用
法如下:
(1)询问姓名,—What’syourname?你的名字是什么?—Alan.艾伦。
(2)询问某物用英语怎么说。—What’sthisinEnglish?—It’satelephone.这是一部电话。
(3)询问电话号码。—What’syourtelephone/phonenumber?你的电话号码是多少?
—It’s563-4789.是5634789.
6.基数词的用法。
数词分为两大类:基数词和序数词,表示“多少”的为基数词;表示“第几”的为序数词。
基数词有zero,one,two等。序数词我们刚学了一个“first”(第一)。其中基数词的用法如下:
(1)表示数字、年龄、日期等,在剧中可作主语、定语和表语。—What’stwoandfive?二加上五等于几?
—Seven七(表示数字)
—Howoldisit?它几岁了?
—It’sfour.它四岁了。(表示年龄)
—What’sthedatetoday?今天几月几日?
—It’sOctober3.10月3日。(表示日期)
(2)表示编号:LessonOne第一课UnitOne第一单元
(3)表示号码,如电话号码、门牌号、身份证号等,按单个基数词读出。0可以读成字母o
的读音或zero,相连的相同两位数可以读成double(双写的)+基数词。
(4)表示时刻:8::00=eighto’clock8点钟
7.汉语名字在英语中的写法
中国人名是姓在前,名在后。姓和名的首字母都要大写且中间空一格,若名为两个字,中间
不加空格,只需第一字的首字母大写。ZhangLing张玲LiuYifei刘亦菲
仁爱英语七年级上册课件 篇3
Unit 5
一 、教学目标
(一)语言知识
语音 /t/ /d/ /ts/ /dz/ /tr/ /dr/ /l/ /m/ /n/
词汇 掌握wake,early,first,day,term,must,still,by,on foot,the same to,usually,always,Ms.,boat,ship,sea,train,by plane/air/airplane, etc.
理解 Subway Worm reporter,Net Bar,roller skating Measure dining hall,dormitory bookstore,etc.
(二)语法
1.一般现在时(Simple present)
2.频度副词(Adverbs of frequency)never, seldom, sometimes, often, usually, always, once, twice
3.现在进行时(Present continuous)
I’m looking for a book.
Are you doing your homework?Yes, I am./No, Im not.
Is he/she...?Yes, he/she is./No, he/she isn’t.
What are you doing now?I’m playing computer games.
What is he/she doing?He/She is...
4.谈论交通方式(Talking about means of transport)
How do you usually go to school? I usually go to school by bike.
(三)功能用语与话题
1.采访(Interviews)Our guest today is Michael from Class 2, Grade 1.
2.谈论日常生活(Talking about routines)
3.学校建筑(School buildings)swimming pool, playground, library, dormitory, lab, canteen, gym
4.谈论兴趣喜好(Talking about interests, likes and dislikes)I like the swimming pool best. Why do you like English? Because it’s interesting and easy.
5.借物(Borrowing things)How long can I keep it? Two weeks.
6.新闻(News)、海报(Poster)Attention, please! Here is the news.
7.谈论学校活动、科目和时间表(Talking about school activities, subjects and timetable)
8.谈论学校生活(Talking about school life)
(四)能力培养
听 能听懂谈论校园生活中比较熟悉的话题,识别主题,获取主要信息。
说 1能根据提示词说出意思连贯的校园生活的句子。
2能用简单对话描述校园生活。
3能根据图片或借助他人帮助描述自己或他人的校园生活。
4能与他人合作进行角色扮演,表现校园生活。
读 1能理解简单的书面表达。
2能准确地朗读课文。
3能读懂表现校园生活方面的.文章,包括校园新闻、海报、遗失声明、失物招领等。
写 能写出表现校园生活方面的简单句子。能写出简单的校园新闻、海报、遗失声明、失物招领等。
情感态度 培养学生积极向上的情感、活泼开朗的个性、浓厚的学习兴趣和大胆实践的精神,提高学习效率,培养学生热爱学校生活,乐于学校生活的意识。
学习策略 积极探索适合自己的英语学习方法,利用现实生活中的学习资源,培养任务型学习方法与技巧。
二、教材分析
本单元的交际用语主要是围绕学生的学校生活展开的,谈论学生的上学方式、作息时间、课程安排、业余生活等内容,这些内容为学生所熟悉,便于展开讨论。
本单元的语法内容主要是学习一般现在时、现在进行时以及表示频度的副词。
Topic 1
Section A
教学目标:
1.谈论交通工具及如何上学。
2.学习句型:How do you usually come to school?
I usually come to school by subway.
本课重点1a和3a。难点:谈论交通工具及如何上学。
教具 录音机
五指教学方案
课时建议:1~2
教学过程:
第一步:复习
1.教学生如何在开学的第一天相互问候。
T: Good morning, class! S: Good morning, Miss.../Mr...
T: Nice to see you again! S: Nice to see you, too.
学习问候语:
T: Happy New Year! S: The same to you.
然后老师说:Boys and is the first day of our new term.
解释today, new term。
老师说:I often come to school by bus. My son often takes the subway to school. What about you?
学习词组by bus, take the subway。
Notes: subway(AmE)=underground(BrE)
2. 听录音3a,回答问题:
(1)How does Kangkang usually come to school?
(2)How does Sally always come to school?
两人一组作对话,然后请3~4对同学到前面表演对话。(对参加表演的同学给予鼓励。)完成3b。
第二步:呈现
1.老师向一些同学依次展示并学习词组:wake up, get up, go to school, by bike等,然后做动作练习。要一名同学在前作动作,其余同学猜测词组。
2.听录音1,回答问题:
What’s the time? / Is it time to get up?
Who wakes Kangkang up? 完成1。
3.利用图画,完成2。
4.听录音4,完成4。
第三步:巩固
1.放录音1和3a,学生跟读。
2.学生两人一组表演1和3a。
第四步:练习
1.分组活动,谈论自己早晨的活动情况。
2.双人活动,分别用不同的交通工具图片进行问答:
A:How do you usually come to school?
B:I usually come to school...
例如:on foot, by bike, by bus, by car, by train, by subway, by boat/ship, by plane/air,完成4。
3.让学生做一个调查报告,调查全班同学“How do you usually go to school?”按人数从多到少列成表格,向大家汇报:
In our class, fifteen students go to school by bike...完成5。
第五步:综合探究活动
1.学生以表格的形式展示自己的家人通常所采用的交通方式。
2.请同学据自己所了解的情况,介绍其它中学生早晨的活动情况,如:
“In our class, some students usually wake up at 6∶30. They get up at 6∶35...”
仁爱英语七年级上册课件 篇4
Unit1 Topic 2 Where are you from?
学习目标:
1.学习数字0-10 及短语zero, one, two, three, four, five, six, seven, eight, nine, ten ,telephone, number
What’s his telephone number?
His telephone number is (010)8267-6790.
3.了解单词音节和重音。做到语音正确。
2. (朗读句子,并标出语调,巩固be from在不同人称的应用,复习国家名称。) Step2 问题导学 A.选择最佳答案
( )1 —Are they from Canada? —No, they ____.
( )2. —What’s ____ telephone number?
—It’s 8265-3412.
( )3. —____ are they? —They are XiaoLi and Jane.
( )4.. Mary ____ from Cuba.
( )5. “One one zero” 表示 ____。
( )6.. —Is he Li Ping? —Yes, ____.
1. —W____ are you from? 2. —What’s y____ name? —I’m from Shanghai. —My name is David.
3. —Are you f____ Zhengzhou? —No, we aren’t.
4. —What’s your telephone n ?—It’s (010)8659-7981.
5. —E me, are you Frank? —Yes, I am.
2. (师连续读出这11个数字,强调前10个数字用升调,最后一个用降调,并要求学生跟读,培养学生语感。)
3.(做出打电话的动作,理解telephone number的意思。)
T:What’s your telephone number?
1— W____ is he? —He i____ Xiao Ming.
2. —Is she ____ Japan? —No, she ____.
3. —W ____ are they from? —They are from C____.
4. —What’s y____ QQ number?
—____ QQ number is 158141028.
5. —____ she Jane? —____, she is.
What’s your telephone number? My telephone number is
What’s his telephone number?His telephone number is
( ) 6. How old are you?
( ) 7. Where are you from?
( ) 8. What’s your telephone number?
( ) 9. Is Miss Yang your English teacher?
( ) 10. Glad to meet you.
B.用适当的词填空。 Hello! My 1 is Kangkang. 2 am from China. This 3 my friend. 4 is his name? His name is Mike. 5 is from the U.S.A. His phone 6 is (010)6534-8719. Miss Zhao 7 my teacher. 8 is she from? She is from China, 9 . She is fine. 10 telephone number is (010)6534-8897.
1. ___________ 2. ___________ 3. ___________ 4. ___________
5. ___________ 6. ___________ 7. ___________
9. ___________ 10. ___________ 8. ___________